142 87 12MB
English Pages 268 [266] Year 2023
Erkan Yuce Shahram Minaei
Passive and Active Circuits by Example
Passive and Active Circuits by Example
Erkan Yuce • Shahram Minaei
Passive and Active Circuits by Example
Erkan Yuce Department of Electrical and Electronics Engineering Pamukkale University Denizli, Türkiye
Shahram Minaei Department of Electrical and Electronics Engineering Dogus University Istanbul, Türkiye
ISBN 978-3-031-44965-9 ISBN 978-3-031-44966-6 https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6
(eBook)
© The Editor(s) (if applicable) and The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2024, Corrected Publication 2024 This work is subject to copyright. All rights are solely and exclusively licensed by the Publisher, whether the whole or part of the material is concerned, specifically the rights of translation, reprinting, reuse of illustrations, recitation, broadcasting, reproduction on microfilms or in any other physical way, and transmission or information storage and retrieval, electronic adaptation, computer software, or by similar or dissimilar methodology now known or hereafter developed. The use of general descriptive names, registered names, trademarks, service marks, etc. in this publication does not imply, even in the absence of a specific statement, that such names are exempt from the relevant protective laws and regulations and therefore free for general use. The publisher, the authors, and the editors are safe to assume that the advice and information in this book are believed to be true and accurate at the date of publication. Neither the publisher nor the authors or the editors give a warranty, expressed or implied, with respect to the material contained herein or for any errors or omissions that may have been made. The publisher remains neutral with regard to jurisdictional claims in published maps and institutional affiliations. This Springer imprint is published by the registered company Springer Nature Switzerland AG The registered company address is: Gewerbestrasse 11, 6330 Cham, Switzerland Paper in this product is recyclable.
Preface
In the past three decades, research and development of active building blocks have been rapidly increased. While operational amplifier-based circuits still find nice applications, new active elements derived from concept of current conveyors have emerged as alternatives for designing active filters, simulated inductors, etc. This book deals with analysis and design of different types of active filters, simulated inductors, etc. through giving more than 200 examples. The text comprises nine chapters that are chosen to provide a complete source for the researchers, undergraduate students, and graduate students who are working on the applications and designs of active filters, simulated inductors, oscillators, rectifiers, etc. with new active elements. Chapter 1 introduces basic concepts such as symbols, units, and prefixes. Several fundamental functions such as constant, sine wave, full-wave rectified, positive halfwave rectified, square wave, triangular wave, sawtooth wave, exponential, delta, unit step, and unit ramp functions versus time are given, where 1 MHz frequency is taken for all the periodical signals. Sensitivity analysis with three examples are treated in which an arbitrary function, an RLC circuit, and two bipolar junction transistor (BJT)-based structures are used. Chapter 2 treats analog signals and systems. The concepts involving linearity, non-linearity, time-invariant, time-variant, linear time-invariant, and causality are briefly explained. Total harmonic distortion is defined, which is explained with an NMOS transistor-based simple amplifier. Definitions of Laplace and Fourier transforms are given. Ideal, second-order ideal, and first-order ideal transfer functions are discussed in detail. Chapter 3 investigates the basic passive elements, resistor, capacitor, and inductor. Current and voltage relations of these passive elements in the time domain, s domain, and frequency domain are also given. Phase and magnitude of any impedance are explained by means of many practices. Fundamental RC and RL circuits and their operating frequency ranges are given. Parallel and/or series RLC circuits are analyzed with some examples. Time domain, s domain, and frequency domain analyses for the series and parallel RC, RL, and RLC circuits are given with v
vi
Preface
some examples. Quality factors of the series and parallel RC, RL, and RLC circuits are explained. Numerous SPICE simulation results are also included to explain the given circuits in which ideal elements are used. Chapter 4 describes passive component-based voltage, current, transimpedance and transadmittance-mode first-order, second-order, and high-order filter transfer functions in detail. In the filter realizations, resistors, capacitors, and inductors are used. Combinations of resistors, capacitors, and inductors implement all the filter transfer functions. Chapter 5 deals with operational amplifiers and their applications. Some fundamental circuits based on ideal operational amplifiers are given. Several restrictions of the operational amplifier-based circuits are exhibited. Many circuits such as simulated grounded inductors, rectifiers, oscillators, and filters employing operational amplifier(s) are given. Slew rate limitations with numerous examples are given. Fullpower bandwidth is defined. Chapter 6 introduces unity gain cells, i.e., current followers and voltage followers. Current and voltage follower-based many analog circuits, for example, amplifier/attenuator, integrator, differentiator, voltage-mode filters, adder, all-pass filters, instrumentation amplifiers, etc., are given. Chapter 7 describes unity gain inverting amplifiers and negative impedance converters. A number of circuits for realizing different transfer functions, firstorder voltage-mode all-pass filters, and one first-order current-mode universal filter based on a single unity gain amplifier are given. Afterward, many circuits based on negative impedance converter(s) are investigated. Chapter 8 deals with current-mode active devices, current conveyors (CCs). These CCs are called first-generation CC (CCI), second-generation CC (CCII), and third-generation CC, and subtractor-connected CCI, current-controlled CCII (CCCII), inverting CCII, differential CC, dual X CCII, differential voltage CC, differential difference CC, fully differential CCII, current differencing CC, and extra X CCCII. A number of circuits for instance simulated inductors, oscillators, rectifiers, filters, etc. are investigated. Chapter 9 introduces other important active components, namely current feedback operational amplifier, operational transresistance amplifier, four-terminal floating nullor, operational transconductance amplifier, voltage differencing inverting buffered amplifier, voltage differencing buffer amplifier, current differencing buffered amplifier, current amplifier, current follower transconductance amplifier, current differencing transconductance amplifier, differential voltage current conveyor transconductance amplifier, and current operational amplifier. Simulated inductors are generally given as application examples for these active devices. Denizli, Türkiye Istanbul, Türkiye August 2023
Erkan Yuce Shahram Minaei
Acknowledgments
The authors would like to thank Prof. Dr. Aydin Kizilkaya, Prof. Dr. Sezai Tokat, Associate Prof. Dr. Firat Yucel, Assistant Prof. Dr. Tolga Yucehan, and Assistant Mehmet Dogan for their helpful suggestions. The author Erkan Yuce would like to dedicate the book to his wife Yildiz Yuce, his daughters Rana Nur Yuce, Gulsu Nur Yuce and his parents. The author Shahram Minaei would like to dedicate the book to his wife Elham Minayi, his daughter Aylin Minayi and his parents.
vii
Contents
1
Basic Concepts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1 Symbols, Units, and Prefixes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 Some Fundamental Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.3 Sensitivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . .
1 1 1 6 10
2
Signals, Systems, and Filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1 Fundamentals of the Signals and Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2 Laplace and Fourier Transforms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3 Ideal Filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4 Ideal Second-Order Filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5 Ideal First-Order Filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11 11 15 17 19 29 34
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1 Passive Circuit Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 Passive Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3 RC and RL Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.4 RLC Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
35 35 35 46 61 72
4
Main Transfer Functions of the Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1 Definition of the Filter Transfer Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1.1 VM FTF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1.2 CM FTF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1.3 TIM FTF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1.4 TAM FTF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 First-Order VM FTFs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2.1 VM LPF TFs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2.2 VM HPF TFs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2.3 VM APF TFs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
73 73 73 74 74 75 75 75 77 78 ix
x
Contents
4.3 First-Order CM FTFs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4 Second-Order VM FTFs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.5 Second-Order CM FTFs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.6 High-Order VM BPF TF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . .
79 81 84 86 87
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1 Practical Operational Amplifiers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2 Ideal OAs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3 OA-Based Basic Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 Some More Examples Based on the OA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.5 Finite Open Loop Gain of the OA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.6 Practical Open Loop Gain OA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7 Expression of the Open Loop Gain in the Frequency Domain . . . 5.8 Gain Bandwidth Product . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9 DC Supply Voltage Restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.10 Simulated Grounded Inductors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.10.1 Lossy SGIs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.10.2 Lossless SGIs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.11 Rectifiers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.12 Wien Oscillators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.13 Analog Filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.14 Large Signal Operation in the OA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.15 SR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.16 Full-Power Bandwidth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
89 89 90 92 106 108 110 116 118 121 123 123 128 132 135 138 144 145 149 150
6
Unity Gain Cells . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1 Unity Gain Cells . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2 CFs and Their Practices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3 VFs and Their Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.4 CF and VF-Based Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
151 151 151 166 168 174
7
Unity Gain Inverting Amplifiers and Negative Impedance Converters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2 UGIAs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3 NICs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
175 175 175 179 188
Current Conveyors and Their Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.2 CCI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.3 CCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
189 189 189 193
8
. . . .
Contents
xi
8.3.1
Realizations of the Other Active Devices Based on the CCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.3.2 Realizations of the Instrumentation Amplifier Based on the CCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.3.3 Realizations of the Simulated Inductors Based on the CCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.3.4 Realizations of the QOs Based on the CCII . . . . . . . . . . 8.3.5 Realizations of the CCII- Based on the CCII+s . . . . . . . 8.4 CCIII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.5 CCCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.6 ICCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.7 DCCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.8 DXCCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.9 DVCC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.10 DDCC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.11 FDCCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.12 CDCC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.13 EX-CCCII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
194 195 195 199 200 201 203 204 206 208 209 213 216 218 221 223
Other Active Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.2 CFOA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.3 OTRA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.4 FTFN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.5 OTA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.6 VDIBA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.7 VDBA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.8 CDBA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.9 CA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.10 CFTA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.11 CDTA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.12 DVCCTA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.13 COA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
225 225 225 232 234 238 240 242 243 245 246 247 248 250 251
Correction to: Unity Gain Cells . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
C1
9
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
About the Authors
Erkan Yuce was born in 1969 in Nigde, Turkey. He received the B.Sc. degree from Middle East Technical University, the M.Sc. degree from Pamukkale University, and the Ph.D. degree from Bogazici University, all in Electrical and Electronics Engineering in 1994, 1998, and 2006, respectively. He is currently a Professor at the Electrical and Electronics Engineering Department of Pamukkale University. His current research interests include analog circuits, active filters, synthetic inductors, and MOS transistor-based circuits. He is the author or co-author of about 190 papers published in scientific journals or conference proceedings. He is an assistant editor-in-chief of the International Journal of Electronics and Communications (AEU).
Shahram Minaei received the B.Sc. degree in Electrical and Electronics Engineering from Iran University of Science and Technology, Tehran, Iran, in 1993, and the M. Sc. and Ph.D. degrees in Electronics and Communication Engineering from Istanbul Technical University, Istanbul, Turkey, in 1997 and 2001, respectively. He is currently a Professor at the Department of Electrical and Electronics Engineering, Dogus University, Istanbul, Turkey. He has more than 190 publications in scientific journals or conference proceedings. His current field of research concerns current-mode circuits and analog signal processing. Dr. Minaei is editor of the Journal of Circuits, Systems and Computers (JCSC), International Journal of Circuit Theory and Applications (IJCTA), Elektronika ir Elektrotechnika, and editor-in-chief of the AEU – International Journal of Electronics and Communications. xiii
Chapter 1
Basic Concepts
1.1
Symbols, Units, and Prefixes
Symbols, units, and prefixes are very important issues especially in electrical and electronics engineering (EEE). The international system of units (SI) is exhibited in Table 1.1. Numerous units derived from the SI are demonstrated in Table 1.2. Furthermore, unit prefixes are given in Table 1.3 [1]. Example 1.1 Find value of 5 F/m2 in terms of fF/(μm)2 Solution 1.1 5 F/m2 = 5 × 1015 fF/(106 μm)2 = 5 × 1015 fF/1012 (μm)2 = 5 × 103 fF/ (μm)2
1.2
Some Fundamental Functions
It is a well-known fact that functions are very essential issue for science and engineering notably in EEE. Some of the fundamental functions, namely, constant, sine wave, full-wave rectified, positive half-wave rectified, square wave, triangular wave, sawtooth wave, exponential, delta, unit step, and unit ramp functions are introduced in this chapter. A constant function, namely, x1(t), is depicted in Fig. 1.1, where A is a real number and t is time variable. Therefore, the function has a constant value of A for all the times. A sine wave function is called as x2(t) = Bsin(2πft + ψ), where f > 0 is the frequency, |B| is the peak value, and -180° ≤ ψ ≤ 180° is the phase angle. Furthermore, f and B are real numbers, while ω = 2πf is angular frequency, and T = 1/f is the period. The function x2(t) is depicted in Fig. 1.2 in which B = 500 mV, f = 1 MHz, and ψ = 60° are chosen as a practice. A full-wave rectified function at 1 MHz is depicted in Fig. 1.3, while a positive half-wave © The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2024 E. Yuce, S. Minaei, Passive and Active Circuits by Example, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6_1
1
2 Table 1.1 International system of units (SI)
1 Fundamental physical quantity Length Mass Time Electric current Thermodynamic temperature Amount of substance Luminous intensity
Basic Concepts
SI Meter Kilogram Second Ampere Kelvin Mole Candela
SI symbol m kg s A K mol cd
Table 1.2 A number of units derived from the SI Unit(s) Force, weight Frequency Energy, work, heat Electric charge Electric potential (voltage) Magnetic flux Inductance Capacitance Resistance, impedance, reactance Electrical conductance Magnetic flux density Power, radiant flux Angle
SI Newton Hertz Joule Coulomb Volt Weber Henry Farad Ohm
SI symbol N Hz J C V Wb H F Ω
Expressed in SI-based unit kgms-2 s-1 kg.m2.s-2 A.s kg.m2.s-3.A-1 kg.m2.s-2.A-1 kg.m2.s-2.A-2 kg-1.m-2.s4.A2 kg.m2.s-3.A-2
Expressed in other SI unit – – Nm – J/C Vs Wb/A C/V V/A
Siemens Tesla Watt Radian
S T W rad
kg-1.m-2.s3.A2 kg.s-2.A-1 kg.m2.s-3 m.m-1
A/V Wb/m2 J/s –
rectified function at 1 MHz is depicted in Fig. 1.4. In Figs. 1.3 and 1.4, sinusoidal signals with peak 500 mV at 500 kHz and 1 MHz are applied, respectively. In addition, a full-wave rectifier output is obtained from any function by taking absolute value of this function. A square wave function at 1 MHz is demonstrated in Fig. 1.5, while a triangular wave function at 1 MHz is shown in Fig. 1.6. A sawtooth wave function is plotted in Fig. 1.7 at 1 MHz, while an exponential one is given in Fig. 1.8. Further, this exponential function is defined as x3(t) = 0.5exp(-t/10-6) for t ≥ 0. δΔ(t) function is shown in Fig. 1.9 [2]. Delta function, namely, δ(t), is defined as δðt Þ = lim δΔ ðt Þ Δ→0
ð1:1Þ
uΔ(t) function is exhibited in Fig. 1.10. Unit step function, namely, u(t), is given below.
1.2
Some Fundamental Functions
Table 1.3 Unit prefixes
3
Name Yocto Zepto Atto Femto Pico Angstrom Nano Micro Mili Santi Desi Kilo Mega Giga Tera Peta Exa Zetta Yotta
Symbol y z a f p Ao n μ m c d k M G T P E Z Y
Prefix multiplier ×10-24 ×10-21 ×10-18 ×10-15 ×10-12 ×10-10 ×10-9 ×10-6 ×10-3 ×10-2 ×10-1 ×103 ×106 ×109 ×1012 ×1015 ×1018 ×1021 ×1024 x1(t)
Fig. 1.1 A constant function
A
t
uðt Þ = lim uΔ ðt Þ Δ→0
ð1:2Þ
u(t) function is depicted in Fig. 1.11, and unit ramp function demonstrated in Fig. 1.12 is computed as follows: t
uðτÞdτ = tuðt Þ
r ðt Þ =
ð1:3Þ
-1
Some relations among δ(t), u(t), and r(t) functions are given below. uð t Þ =
dr ðt Þ dt
ð1:4aÞ
4
1
Basic Concepts
Fig. 1.2 A sine wave function at 1 MHz
Fig. 1.3 A full-wave rectifier function at 1 MHz
δðt Þ =
duðt Þ d2 rðt Þ = dt dt 2
ð1:4bÞ
1.2
Some Fundamental Functions
5
Fig. 1.4 A half-wave rectifier function at 1 MHz
Fig. 1.5 A square wave function at 1 MHz t
uð t Þ =
δðτÞdτ -1
ð1:4cÞ
6
1
Basic Concepts
Fig. 1.6 A triangular wave function at 1 MHz
Fig. 1.7 A sawtooth wave function at 1 MHz
1.3
Sensitivity
The sensitivity, namely, the robustness of the outcomes of any models, deals with the effect of independent parameters on the dependent ones. Sensitivity of any function y(x, z, w) to x is defined in Eq. (1.5).
1.3
Sensitivity
7
Fig. 1.8 An exponential function G'(t)
Fig. 1.9 Representation of δΔ(t) function
1/'
-'/2 '/2
t
u'(t)
Fig. 1.10 Representation of uΔ(t) function
1 1/2
'
-'
Fig. 1.11 Representation of u(t) function
t
u(t) 1
t
8
1
Basic Concepts
r(t)
Fig. 1.12 Representation of r(t) function
1 t
∂yðx, z, wÞ x yðx, z, wÞ ∂x
Syxðx,z,wÞ =
ð1:5Þ
Note It is desired that sensitivities of any functions should be small in magnitude [3–8]. Example 1.2 Find the sensitivity of function F(x) to x shown below in which B is a real number. F ðxÞ =
x x-B
ð1:6Þ
Solution 1.2 The sensitivity of the function F(x) given above with respect to x is evaluated as in the following: SFx ðxÞ =
x x x-B
d x B = dx x - B B-x
ð1:7Þ
Note It is observed from Eq. (1.7) that if x approaches to B, sensitivity goes to infinity in magnitude. As a result, the function given in (1.6) is an undesired function due to sensitivity point of view. Example 1.3 A parallel/series RLC circuit has the angular resonance frequency (ω0) as given in Eq. (1.8). Thus, find the sensitivities of ω0 to both passive elements. 1 ω0 = p LC
ð1:8Þ
Solution 1.3 The sensitivities of ω0 to both passive elements are found as SωL 0 =
L dω0 1 =ω0 dL 2
ð1:9aÞ
SωC0 =
1 C dω0 =2 ω0 dC
ð1:9bÞ
1.3
Sensitivity
9 VCC
Fig. 1.13 A simple BJT-based circuit VBB
RB
IC1
VCC
Fig. 1.14 A BJT-based circuit with a resistor in emitter VBB
RB
IC2
RE
In order to express sensitivity more, bipolar junction transistor (BJT)-based simple circuits operated in the forward active region are given in Figs. 1.13 and 1.14 as examples. It is assumed that both BJTs are identical. Thus, collector currents of the topologies given in Figs. 1.13 and 1.14 are, respectively, computed as [9] βF ðV BB - V BE Þ RB
ð1:10aÞ
βF ðV BB - V BE Þ RB þ ðβF þ 1ÞRE
ð1:10bÞ
I C1 = I C2 =
Sensitivities of the collector currents demonstrated in Figs. 1.13 and 1.14 to the current gain (βF = IC/IB) can be, respectively, given below. βF dI C1 =1 I C1 dβF
ð1:11aÞ
βF dI C2 RB þ RE = I C2 dβF RB þ ðβF þ 1ÞRE
ð1:11bÞ
= SIβC1 F = SIβC2 F
One observes from the equations denoted in (1.11a) and (1.11b) that the circuit in Fig. 1.14 is less sensitive than one exhibited in Fig. 1.13 due to the resistor RE. In Eqs. (1.11a) and (1.11b), dIC1/dβF and dIC2/dβF are, respectively, evaluated by dI C1 V BB - V BE = dβF RB
ð1:12aÞ
10
1
Basic Concepts
dI C2 ðV BB - V BE ÞðRB þ ðβF þ 1ÞRE Þ - βF ðV BB - V BE ÞRE = dβF ðRB þ ðβF þ 1ÞRE Þ2 ðV BB - V BE ÞðRB þ RE Þ = ðRB þ ðβF þ 1ÞRE Þ2
ð1:12bÞ
It is understood from above that sensitivity gives a measure for performances of the circuit with respect to their elements or parameters. In other words, it provides selection of the adequate element tolerances [10].
References 1. J.W. Nilsson, S.A. Riedel, Electric Circuits, 10th edn. (Pearson, 2015) 2. A.V. Oppenheim, A.S. Willsky, S.H. Nawab, Signals and Systems, Pearson New International Edition (Pearson Education Limited, Harlow, 2013) 3. A.B. Williams, Analog Filter and Circuit Design Handbook (McGraw Hill Professional, 2013) 4. R. Schaumann, M.E.V. Valkenburg, Design of Analog Filters (Oxford University Press, 2001) 5. A.F. Anday, Aktif devre sentezi (Istanbul Technical University, 1992) 6. A. Anand, M. Agrawal, N. Bhatt, M. Ram, Advances in System Reliability Engineering (Elsevier, Academic, 2019), pp. 267–279 7. E.A. Ustinov, Sensitivity Analysis in Remote Sensing (Springer Briefs in Earth Sciences, 2015) 8. https://www.embedded.com/analyzing-circuit-sensitivity-for-analog-circuit-design/ 9. A.S. Sedra, K.C. Smith, T.C. Carusone, V. Gaudet, Microelectronic Circuits, 8th edn. (Oxford University Press, New York, 2020) 10. N.B. Hamida, B. Kaminska, Multiple fault analog circuit testing by selectivity analysis. Analog Integr. Circ. Sig. Process 4(3), 231–243 (1993)
Chapter 2
Signals, Systems, and Filters
2.1
Fundamentals of the Signals and Systems
Signals can be mainly divided into two subcategories, voltage and current ones. Furthermore, they can be separated into two subgroups, analog and digital ones [1]. In this book, we concentrate on the analog voltage and current signals. Linearity and time-invariance are other important issues. However, full-wave rectifier configurations are nonlinear, while rheostat is a variable resistor. It is assumed that active and passive circuits given in Figs. 2.1 and 2.2 are linear time-invariant (LTI). The circuits exhibited in Figs. 2.1 and 2.2 are examples for the circuit analysis and circuit synthesis, respectively. In Fig. 2.1, vin(t) and the circuit are known, where the output is required. Additionally, in Fig. 2.2, vin(t) and vout(t) are known in which the circuit is required. In Fig. 2.1, the circuit has only a single output voltage, while the topology in Fig. 2.2 can be implemented in several methods [2]. If the circuit in Fig. 2.1 is an active structure, its output voltage with respect to the input voltage can be defined as follows [3]: vout ðt Þ = f ðvin ðt ÞÞ =
1 k=0
ak ðt Þvink ðt Þ
= a0 ðt Þ þ a1 ðt Þvin ðt Þ þ
ð2:1Þ a2 ðt Þv2in ðt Þ
þ ...
where v0in(t) = 1, ak(t) (k = 0, 1, 2, . . .) is a complex number and k of vkin(t) represents kth exponent. The circuit is nonlinear and time-varying for a0(t) ≠ 0, even if it is as in the following form:
© The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2024 E. Yuce, S. Minaei, Passive and Active Circuits by Example, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6_2
11
12
2
Fig. 2.1 A circuit used in the analysis
+ vin(t) _
Fig. 2.2 A circuit utilized in the synthesis
Signals, Systems, and Filters
Given circuit
+ vin(t) _
+ Calculated output
_
Required circuit
+ vout(t) _
1
vout ðt Þ = k=0
ak ðt Þvkin ðt Þ = a0 ðt Þ þ a1 ðt Þvin ðt Þ
ð2:2Þ
The circuit in Fig. 2.1 is linear if its output voltage is as in the following: vout ðt Þ = a1 ðt Þvin ðt Þ
ð2:3Þ
However, equation in (2.3) is time-varying. Apart from this, if the circuit in Fig. 2.1 is time-invariant, it has generally the following equation: vout ðt Þ =
1
ak vkin ðt Þ
ð2:4Þ
k=0
If the configuration in Fig. 2.1 is LTI, it can be defined below. vout ðt Þ = a1 vin ðt Þ
ð2:5Þ
An LTI circuit can be generally shown as n
bk k=0
dk vout ðt Þ = dt k
m
ai i=0
di vin ðt Þ dt i
ð2:6Þ
where a0(d0v(t)/dt0) = a0v(t), bk (k = 0, 1, 2, . . . , n), and ai (i = 0, 1, 2, . . ., m) are time-invariant complex numbers. Also, n ≥ m is required for causality [3]. Input voltage signal and corresponding output voltage signal can be, respectively, demonstrated by vin ðt Þ = A sinðωt Þ
ð2:7aÞ
2.1
Fundamentals of the Signals and Systems
13 VDD
Fig. 2.3 An NMOS transistor-based simple amplifier circuit [4]
RD
iD(t) vout(t)
M
vin(t)
VA
vout ðtÞ =
1
ð2:7bÞ
Bk cosðkωtÞ k=0
From Eq. (2.7b), the total harmonic distortion (THD) is defined as
THD = 100 ×
1 k=2
Bk B1
2
ð2:8Þ
One observes from equation given in (2.8) that DC term of the output signal is not utilized in calculation of the THD. Furthermore, the first nine harmonics including fundamental harmonic are taken in the SPICE simulation program. Example 2.1 Find the THD value of the NMOS transistor-based simple amplifier in Fig. 2.3. Solution 2.1 It is assumed that the transistor operates in the saturation region. If the channel-length modulation effect is ignored, drain current of the circuit in Fig. 2.3 is computed as iD ðt Þ = I D þ id ðt Þ þ io ðt Þ 1 = k n ðvin ðt Þ - V A - V TN Þ2 2 1 1 = k n ð - V A - V TN Þ2 þ kn ð - V A - V TN Þvin ðt Þ þ kn v2in ðt Þ 2 2
ð2:9Þ
Here, VTN is the threshold voltage of the NMOS transistor, while kn is transconductance parameter. In addition, VA is sufficiently less than -VTN. Thus, constant current (ID), desired current (id(t)), and other current (io(t)) signals are, respectively, calculated as ID =
1 k ð- V A - V TN Þ2 2 n
ð2:10aÞ
14
2
Signals, Systems, and Filters
id ðt Þ = kn ð- V A - V TN Þvin ðt Þ io ðt Þ =
1 2 k v ðt Þ 2 n in
ð2:10bÞ ð2:10cÞ
Note cos(2ω0t) = 2cos2(ω0t) - 1. If vin(t) = Acos(ω0t) is chosen, id(t) and io(t) are, respectively, computed by id ðt Þ = k n ð- V A - V TN ÞA cosðω0 t Þ 1 1 1 þ cos ð2ω0 t Þ io ðt Þ = kn ðA cos ðω0 t ÞÞ2 = kn A2 2 2 2 1 2 1 2 = kn A þ kn A cos ð2ω0 t Þ 4 4 = I DC þ iu ðt Þ
ð2:11aÞ
ð2:11bÞ
From (2.11b), IDC and undesired current (iu(t)) are, respectively, written as 1 k A2 4 n
ð2:12aÞ
1 k A2 cosð2ω0 t Þ 4 n
ð2:12bÞ
I DC = i u ðt Þ =
vout(t) of the circuit exhibited in Fig. 2.3 is found as in the following: vout ðt Þ = V DD - RD × iD ðt Þ = V DD - RD × ðI D þ id ðt Þ þ io ðt ÞÞ = V DD - RD × ðI D þ I DC þ id ðt Þ þ iu ðt ÞÞ
ð2:13Þ
If constant currents in vout(t) of equation in (2.13) are ignored, AC part of the output voltage (vout/(t)) is obtained as =
vout ðt Þ = RD × ðid ðt Þ þ iu ðt ÞÞ 1 = RD × k n ð - V A - V TN ÞA cos ðω0 t Þ þ k n A2 cos ð2ω0 t Þ 4 = B1 cos ðω0 t Þ þ B2 cos ð2ω0 t Þ
ð2:14Þ
Here, B1 = RD × kn(-VA-VTN)A and B2 = RD × knA2/4. Finally, THD of the circuit in Fig. 2.3 is evaluated as
2.2
Laplace and Fourier Transforms
THD = 100 ×
1 k=2
Bk B1
15
2
2
Bk B1
= 100 × k=2
2
1 RD × kn A2 A 4 = 25 × = 100 × RD × k n ð - V A - V TN ÞA - V A - V TN
2.2
ð2:15Þ
Laplace and Fourier Transforms
By taking all the initial conditions zero, Laplace transforms of vin(t) and vout(t) in Fig. 2.2 are, respectively, found as follows: V in ðsÞ =
1 -1
vin ðtÞe - st dt
ð2:16aÞ
1
vout ðt Þe - st dt
V out ðsÞ =
ð2:16bÞ
-1
By using equations given in (2.6), (2.16a), and (2.16b), a transfer function (TF) can be defined as m
V ðsÞ H ðsÞ = out = V in ðsÞ
i=0 n j=0
ai si ð2:17Þ bj sj
In Eq. (2.17), real parts of all the poles must be negative for the stability. The following condition, m ≤ n (m ≥ 0 and n ≥ 1) is required for the causality. If m ≥ 1 and n ≥ 1, the equation in (2.17) can be expressed as follows: m
H ðsÞ = K
j=1 n i=1
s þ zj ð s þ pi Þ
ð2:18Þ
Here, K = am/bn. Also, -pi (i = 1, 2, 3,. . ., n) and -zj ( j = 1, 2, 3,. . ., m) are poles and zeroes, respectively. pi given in Eq. (2.18) can be written as
16
2
pi = σ i þ jωi
Signals, Systems, and Filters
ð2:19Þ
If real part of pi = σ i > 0, it is stable. If σ i = 0 and ωi ≠ ωk (k = 1, 2, 3, . . ., n and i ≠ k), it is marginally stable. Otherwise, it is unstable. By taking all the initial conditions zero, Fourier transform of vin(t) in Fig. 2.2 is found as Vin(ω). Likewise, Fourier transform of vout(t) is computed as Vout(ω). Vin(ω) and Vout(ω) are, respectively, given by 1
V in ðωÞ =
vin ðt Þe - jωt dt
ð2:20aÞ
vout ðt Þe - jωt dt
ð2:20bÞ
-1 1
V out ðωÞ = -1
By using equations in (2.20a) and (2.20b), TF of the circuit can be defined as H ð ωÞ =
V out ðωÞ V in ðωÞ
ð2:21Þ
Equation given in (2.21) can be expressed by HðωÞ = jHðωÞjej∠HðωÞ
ð2:22Þ
where ∠H(ω) is phase and |H(ω)| is gain. Thus, the relationship between input and output of the circuit in the time domain and frequency domain are, respectively, given as vout ðt Þ = hðt Þ vin ðt Þ
ð2:23aÞ
V out ðωÞ = H ðωÞV in ðωÞ
ð2:23bÞ
Here, h(t) is impulse response of the LTI topology, while H(ω) is its Fourier transform. In addition, * is the convolution operator. Note Gain of the passive circuit is between zero and one, while gain of the active configuration can be any positive or negative real numbers. In other words, gain of the active circuit can be more or less than unity in magnitude [1].
2.3
2.3
Ideal Filters
17
Ideal Filters
Ideal low-pass filter (LPF), band-pass filter (BPF), notch filter (NF), and high-pass filter (HPF) have noncausal TFs, but they can be tried to realize with some approximations such as Butterworth, Chebyshev, etc. TFs of the LPF, BPF, NF and HPF are, respectively, demonstrated in Figs. 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, and 2.7, while ideal all-pass filter (APF) TF that is causal is exhibited in Fig. 2.8. ωC in Figs. 2.4 and 2.7 is angular cutoff frequency. Additionally, ω1 and ω2 in Figs. 2.5 and 2.6 are angular cutoff frequencies. LPF has a bandwidth (BW) of ωC, while HPF and APF possess
Fig. 2.4 Characteristics of the ideal LPF
H LP ( )
1
0 Fig. 2.5 Characteristics of the ideal BPF
C
H BP ( )
1
0 Fig. 2.6 Characteristics of the ideal NF
1
2
1
2
H NF ( )
1
0
18
2
Signals, Systems, and Filters
H HP ( )
Fig. 2.7 Characteristics of the ideal HPF
1
0
C
H AP ( )
Fig. 2.8 Characteristics of the ideal APF
1
0 infinity BW. BPF and NF have the following equations for ωC, BW, and quality factor (Q) [5, 6]: ω2C = ω1 × ω2
ð2:24aÞ
BW = ω2 - ω1 ω Q= C BW
ð2:24bÞ ð2:24cÞ
ωC of BPF and NF in Figs. 2.5 and 2.6 is angular resonance frequency or center frequency. Ideal filters demonstrated in Figs. 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, and 2.8 can be, respectively, expressed as jH LP ðωÞj = jH BP ðωÞj = jH NF ðωÞj =
1
1 ω ≤ ωC 0 ω > ωC ω 1 ≤ ω ≤ ω2
0 ω < ω1 and ω > ω2 1 0
ω ≤ ω1 and ω ≥ ω2 ω1 < ω < ω 2
ð2:25aÞ ð2:25bÞ ð2:25cÞ
2.4
Ideal Second-Order Filters
19
jH HP ðωÞj =
1 0
ω ≥ ωC ω < ωC
jH AP ðωÞj = 1 ω ≥ 0
ð2:25dÞ ð2:25eÞ
Note For the characteristics given in Figs. 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, and 2.8, the negative frequency responses are ignored.
2.4
Ideal Second-Order Filters
A second-order universal filter can realize all the LPF, BPF, NF, HPF, and APF responses [7]. Non-inverting second-order unity gain LPF, BPF, NF, HPF, and APF phase and gain responses for different Q values are, respectively, depicted in Figs. 2.9, 2.10, 2.11, 2.12, and 2.13, which are obtained by using one resistor, one capacitor, and one inductor. Resonance frequency of these filter circuits is taken as f0 ffi 1.59 MHz. Non-inverting second-order unity gain LPF, BPF, NF, HPF, and APF in Figs. 2.9, 2.10, 2.11, 2.12, and 2.13 are, respectively, given below. H LP ðsÞ =
ω20 DðsÞ
ð2:26aÞ
Fig. 2.9 Non-inverting second-order unity gain LPF phase and gain responses for different quality factors against frequency
20
2
Signals, Systems, and Filters
Fig. 2.10 Non-inverting second-order unity gain BPF phase and gain responses for different quality factors versus frequency
Fig. 2.11 Non-inverting second-order unity gain NF phase and gain responses for different quality factors with respect to frequency
H BP ðsÞ =
ω0 Q
s DðsÞ
ð2:26bÞ
2.4
Ideal Second-Order Filters
21
Fig. 2.12 Non-inverting second-order unity gain HPF phase and gain responses for different quality factors versus frequency
Fig. 2.13 Non-inverting second-order unity gain APF phase and gain responses for different quality factors against frequency
H NF ðsÞ =
s2 þ ω20 D ðs Þ
ð2:26cÞ
22
2
s2 DðsÞ
H HP ðsÞ = H AP ðsÞ =
Signals, Systems, and Filters
s2 -
ð2:26dÞ
ω0 Q
s þ ω20 DðsÞ
ð2:26eÞ
The denominator, D(s), in Eq. (2.26) is in the form of DðsÞ = s2 þ
ω0 s þ ω20 Q
ð2:27Þ
Here, ω0 is angular resonance frequency, while Q is quality factor. Apart from this, bandwidth (BW) is evaluated by BW =
ω0 Q
ð2:28Þ
An ideal non-inverting second-order unity gain LPF in the frequency domain has, respectively, the following phase and gain responses: ∠H LP ðωÞ = - Arctan
ω0 ω Q ω20 - ω2
ð2:29aÞ
ω20
jH LP ðωÞj = ω20
2 - ω2
þ
ω0 ω Q
2
ð2:29bÞ
It is seen from Fig. 2.9 and equation indicated in (2.29a) that phase responses of the non-inverting second-order LPF will vary from 0° to -180° if the frequency changes from 0° to infinity. Phase of the LPF is equal to -90° at the resonance frequency. In addition, if f >> f0, gain of the LPF decreases with -40 dB/decade. On the other hand, an ideal non-inverting second-order unity gain BPF in frequency domain has, respectively, the following phase and gain responses: ∠H BP ðωÞ = 90 ° - Arctan
ω0 ω Q ω20 - ω2
ð2:30aÞ
ω0 ω Q
jH BP ðωÞj = ω20
2 - ω2
þ
ω0 ω Q
2
ð2:30bÞ
An ideal non-inverting second-order unity gain NF in the frequency domain has, respectively, the following phase and gain responses:
2.4
Ideal Second-Order Filters
23
ω0 ω Q - Arctan ω20 - ω2 ∠H NF ðωÞ =
if ω < ω0
if ω = ω0 ω0 ω Q if ω > ω0 180 ° - Arctan 2 ω0 - ω2 0
ω20 - ω2
jH NF ðωÞj =
ω20 - ω2
2
þ
ω0 ω Q
2
ð2:31aÞ
ð2:31bÞ
Likewise, an ideal non-inverting second-order unity gain HPF in the frequency domain has, respectively, the following phase and gain responses: ∠H HP ðωÞ = 180 ° - Arctan
ω0 ω Q ω20 - ω2
ω2
jH HP ðωÞj = ω20
2 - ω2
þ
ω0 ω Q
2
ð2:32aÞ ð2:32bÞ
Phase of the HPF is equal to 90° at the resonance frequency. In addition, if f ω0 360 ° - Arctan ω20 - ω2
ð2:37Þ
Likewise, an ideal inverting second-order unity gain HPF in the frequency domain has the following phase response: ∠H HP ðωÞ = - Arctan
ω0 ω Q ω20 - ω2
ð2:38Þ
Finally, an ideal inverting second-order unity gain APF in the frequency domain has the following phase response: ∠H AP ðωÞ = 180 ° - 2Arctan
ω0 ω Q 2 ω 0 - ω2
ð2:39Þ
One observes from Eq. (2.39) that phase response varies from 180° to -180° as the frequency goes from zero to infinity. Note For the non-inverting and inverting second-order universal filter responses, magnitudes of the gains can be more or less than unity if active devices are used in the implementation of the filter structures. Example 2.2 Find the frequency of the second-order LPF for Q > 1/√2, where the gain is maximum. Solution 2.2 Derivative of the gain of the second-order LPF defined in Eq. (2.29b) is taken as
28
2 2 2 d jH LP ðωÞj 2 × ω × ω0 ω0 1 = dω 2 ω20 - ω2 þ
Signals, Systems, and Filters
1 2Q2
- ω2
ω0 ω Q
2
ð2:40Þ
3 2
If equation given in (2.40) is taken as zero, maximum frequency value is found. Therefore, the following more simpler equation is obtained as: 1 1 = 0 ) ω2 = ω20 1 2Q2 2Q2
ω2 - ω20 1 -
ð2:41Þ
Therefore, ωmax is evaluated as 1-
ωmax = ± ω0
1 2Q2
ð2:42Þ
However, ωmax > 0; thus, it is found by ωmax = ω0
1-
1 2Q2
ð2:43Þ
Note ωmax = 0 for Q ≤ 1/√2. Example 2.3 Find the ωC of the second-order LPF with respect to ω0 and Q. Solution 2.3 Firstly, |HLP(ω)| = 1/√2 is taken. Afterward, the following equation is obtained: ω20 ω20
2 - ω2
þ
ω0 ω Q
1 =p 2
2
ð2:44Þ
ω = ωC
From equation given in (2.44), the following equation is obtained: ω40 ω20
2 - ω2C
þ
ω0 ωC Q
2
=
1 ) ω20 - ω2C 2
2
þ
ω 0 ωC Q
2
= 2ω40
ð2:45Þ
If the equation given in (2.45) is expanded, the following equation is obtained: Q2 ω4C þ ω20 ω2C - 2Q2 ω20 ω2C - Q2 ω40 = 0 The above equation simplifies as
ð2:46Þ
2.5
Ideal First-Order Filters
29
ω4C - ω2C 2 -
1 ω2 - ω40 = 0 Q2 0
ð2:47Þ
Solution of the equation exhibited in (2.47), the following ωC is found: ωC = ±
ω0 p Q 2
2Q2 - 1 þ
8Q4 - 4Q2 þ 1
ð2:48Þ
Nevertheless, ωC must be greater than zero. The equation in (2.48) turns into ωC =
ω0 p Q 2
2Q2 - 1 þ
8Q4 - 4Q2 þ 1
ð2:49Þ
If Q = 1/√2 is taken, ωC = ω0 is obtained. Example 2.4 Find gains of the ideal second-order LPF, BPF, and HPF. Solution 2.4 Gains of the ideal second-order LPF, BPF, and HPF are, respectively, found as follows: GLP = lim jH LP ðωÞj
ð2:50aÞ
GBP = jH BP ðωÞjω = ω0
ð2:50bÞ
GHP = ωlim j H ð ωÞ j → 1 HP
ð2:50cÞ
ω→0
2.5
Ideal First-Order Filters
It is a well-known fact that a first-order universal filter can realize all the LPF, HPF, and APF responses. Non-inverting and inverting first-order unity gain LPF, HPF, and APF phase and gain responses are, respectively, exhibited in Figs. 2.19, 2.20, and 2.21, which are obtained by using resistors and capacitors. Pole frequency of the filter circuits in these figures is chosen as f0 ffi 1.59 MHz. Non-inverting and inverting first-order unity gain LPF, HPF, and APF shown in Figs. 2.19, 2.20, and 2.21 are, respectively, given as follows: H LP ðsÞ = ±
ω0 DðsÞ
ð2:51aÞ
30
2
Signals, Systems, and Filters
Fig. 2.19 Non-inverting and inverting first-order unity gain LPF phase and gain responses against frequency
Fig. 2.20 Non-inverting and inverting first-order unity gain HPF phase and gain responses versus frequency
2.5
Ideal First-Order Filters
31
Fig. 2.21 Non-inverting and inverting first-order unity gain APF phase and gain responses with respect to frequency
s DðsÞ ω0 - s H AP ðsÞ = ± DðsÞ H HP ðsÞ = ±
ð2:51bÞ ð2:51cÞ
Here, + sign corresponds to the non-inverting filters, while - sign is related to the inverting filters. Further, the denominator, D(s) is given as DðsÞ = s þ ω0
ð2:52Þ
where ω0 is the angular pole frequency. TFs of Eq. (2.51) in the frequency domain convert to H LP ðωÞ = ±
ω0 DðωÞ
ð2:53aÞ
H HP ðωÞ = ±
jω DðωÞ
ð2:53bÞ
ω0 - jω DðωÞ
ð2:53cÞ
H AP ðωÞ = ± Here, the denominator, D(ω) is given by
32
2
DðωÞ = ω0 þ jω
Signals, Systems, and Filters
ð2:54Þ
If the TFs in Eq. (2.53) are non-inverting, they have, respectively, the following phase responses: ∠H LP ðωÞ = - Arctan
ω ω0 ω ω0
∠H HP ðωÞ = 90 ° - Arctan ∠H AP ðωÞ = - 2Arctan
ð2:55aÞ
ω ω0
ð2:55bÞ ð2:55cÞ
One observes from equation in (2.55c) that phase response varies from 0° to -180° as the frequency goes from zero to infinity. Apart from this, if the TFs in Eq. (2.53) are inverting, they have, respectively, the following phase responses: ∠H LP ðωÞ = 180 ° - Arctan
ω ω0
ð2:56aÞ
∠H HP ðωÞ = - 90 ° - Arctan
ω ω0
ð2:56bÞ
∠H AP ðωÞ = 180 ° - 2Arctan
ω ω0
ð2:56cÞ
One sees from equation in (2.56c) that phase response varies from 180° to 0° as the frequency goes from zero to infinity. On the other hand, gains of the TFs of equations in (2.53) can be given below. jH LP ðωÞj = jH HP ðωÞj =
jH AP ðωÞj =
ω0 ω20 þ ω2
ð2:57aÞ
ω þ ω2
ð2:57bÞ
ω20
ω20 þ ð- ωÞ2 ω20 þ ω2
=1
ð2:57cÞ
It is observed from equations in (2.57a) and (2.57b) that gain of the first-order LPF decreases -20 dB/decade if ω >> ω0, while gain of the first-order HPF increases 20 dB/decade if ω > f0, gain of the fourth-order Butterworth LPF decreases as -80 dB/decade.
34
2
Signals, Systems, and Filters
Fig. 2.23 Phase and gain responses of the fourth-order Butterworth LPF versus frequency
References 1. A.S. Sedra, K.C. Smith, T.C. Carusone, V. Gaudet, Microelectronic Circuits, 8th edn. (Oxford University Press, New York, 2020) 2. A.F. Anday, Devre ve sistem analizi çözümlü problemler (Birsen, 2004) 3. A.V. Oppenheim, A.S. Willsky, S.H. Nawab, Signals and Systems, Pearson New International Edition. (Pearson Education Limited, Harlow, 2013) 4. B. Razavi, Fundamentals of Microelectronics: With Robotics and Bioengineering Applications, 3rd edn. (Wiley, 2021) 5. A.B. Williams, Analog Filter and Circuit Design Handbook (McGraw Hill Professional, 2013) 6. R. Schaumann, M.E.V. Valkenburg, Design of Analog Filters (Oxford University Press, 2001) 7. E. Yuce, A single-input multiple-output voltage-mode second-order universal filter using only grounded passive components. Indian J. Eng. Mater. Sci. 24(2), 97–106 (2017) 8. E. Yuce, S. Minaei, H. Alpaslan, Single voltage controlled CMOS grounded resistors and their application to video filter. Indian J. Eng. Mater. Sci. 21(5), 501–509 (2014)
Chapter 3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
3.1
Passive Circuit Elements
Electrical symbols of the fundamental passive elements, resistor, capacitor, and inductor are depicted in Fig. 3.1. Capacitor and inductor are called as energy storage elements and possess memory. However, resistor is memoryless and dissipates power. As state variables, the capacitor has a voltage across its terminals, while the inductor has a current in it. These voltage and current are stated as initial conditions for the capacitor and inductor, respectively. In addition, their current and voltage relationships in the time domain, s domain (complex frequency domain), and frequency domain are given in Table 3.1. It is seen from Table 3.1 that the voltage across the capacitor terminals and the current passing through the inductor are continuous.
3.2
Passive Circuits
Passive elements can be divided into two subcategories: grounded and floating passive elements. Two identical grounded passive circuits are demonstrated in Figs. 3.2 and 3.3. A voltage source is applied to the topology given in Fig. 3.2, while a current source is applied to the same configuration in Fig. 3.3 [1, 2]. Input impedance and admittance of the circuit given in Fig. 3.2 are, respectively, computed as follows: Z=
V test I circuit
© The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2024 E. Yuce, S. Minaei, Passive and Active Circuits by Example, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6_3
ð3:1aÞ
35
36
3
Fig. 3.1 Fundamental passive circuit components (a) resistor, (b) capacitor, and (c) inductor
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
+
IR
+
VR _
R
VC _
(a)
IC C
+
IL
VL _
L
(b)
(c)
Table 3.1 Current and voltage relationships of the fundamental passive circuit components Passive elements Resistor Capacitor Inductor
Domain Time vR(t) = RiR(t) C ðt Þ iC ðt Þ = C dvdt L ðt Þ vL ðt Þ = L didt
s VR(s) = RIR(s) IC(s) = sCVC(s)
Frequency VR(ω) = RIR(ω) IC(ω) = jωCVC(ω)
VL(s) = sLIL(s)
VL(ω) = jωLIL(ω)
Icircuit
Fig. 3.2 A voltage source applied to the grounded passive circuit
Vtest + _
Fig. 3.3 A current source applied to the grounded passive circuit
Itest
Y=
I circuit V test
+ Vcircuit _
Passive circuit
Passive circuit
ð3:1bÞ
Input impedance and admittance of the circuit shown in Fig. 3.3 are, respectively, calculated below. Z=
V circuit I test
ð3:2aÞ
Y=
I test V circuit
ð3:2bÞ
The circuit of Fig. 3.3 has the same input impedance and admittance as the topology in Fig. 3.2 possesses. Example 3.1 Find phase and magnitude of the input impedance of the ideal resistor shown in Fig. 3.4.
3.2
Passive Circuits
37
Vin
Fig. 3.4 An ideal grounded resistor
Iin R
ZR Vin
Fig. 3.5 An ideal grounded capacitor
Iin C
ZC Solution 3.1 The input impedance of the resistor in the frequency domain is evaluated as Z R ð ωÞ =
V in ðωÞ =R I in ðωÞ
ð3:3Þ
Input impedance of the resistor given in Eq. (3.3) can be expressed as Z R ðωÞ = jZ R ðωÞjej∠Z R ðωÞ
ð3:4Þ
Here, ∠ZR(ω) is defined as phase, and |ZR(ω)| is defined as magnitude of the input impedance of the resistor. In addition, they are, respectively, computed as ∠Z R ðωÞ = 0o
ð3:5aÞ
j Z R ð ωÞ j = R
ð3:5bÞ
Example 3.2 Find phase and magnitude of the input impedance of the ideal capacitor depicted in Fig. 3.5. Solution 3.2 The input impedance of the capacitor in the frequency domain is calculated as Z C ðωÞ =
V in ðωÞ 1 1 = = -j jωC ωC I in ðωÞ
Input impedance of the capacitor given in Eq. (3.6) can be expressed as
ð3:6Þ
38
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
Vin
Fig. 3.6 An ideal grounded inductor
Iin L
ZL Z C ðωÞ = jZ C ðωÞjej∠Z C ðωÞ
ð3:7Þ
where ∠ZC(ω) is defined as phase and |ZC(ω)| is defined as magnitude of the input impedance of the capacitor. Further, they are, respectively, computed as ∠Z C ðωÞ = - 90o j Z C ð ωÞ j =
1 ωC
ð3:8aÞ ð3:8bÞ
Example 3.3 Find phase and magnitude of the input impedance of the ideal inductor exhibited in Fig. 3.6. Solution 3.3 The input impedance of the inductor in the frequency domain is found as Z L ð ωÞ =
V in ðωÞ = jωL I in ðωÞ
ð3:9Þ
Similarly, input impedance of the inductor given in Eq. (3.9) can be expressed as Z L ðωÞ = jZ L ðωÞjej∠Z L ðωÞ
ð3:10Þ
where ∠ZL(ω) is defined as phase and |ZL(ω)| is defined as magnitude of the input impedance of the inductor. Moreover, they are, respectively, evaluated below. ∠Z L ðωÞ = 90o
ð3:11aÞ
jZ L ðωÞj = ωL
ð3:11bÞ
Phases and magnitudes of impedances of the ideal grounded resistor in Fig. 3.4, the ideal grounded capacitor in Fig. 3.5, and the ideal grounded inductor in Fig. 3.6 are simulated through the SPICE program. In all the simulations, R = 1 kΩ, C = 10 pF, and L = 100 μH are chosen. Additionally, the frequency in all the AC simulations is taken from 1 kHz to 1 GHz. Their AC simulation results are, respectively, shown in Figs. 3.7, 3.8, and 3.9 for the ideal grounded resistor in Fig. 3.4, the ideal grounded capacitor in Fig. 3.5, and the ideal grounded inductor in
3.2
Passive Circuits
39
Fig. 3.7 Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the resistor exhibited in Fig. 3.4
Fig. 3.8 Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the capacitor depicted in Fig. 3.5
Fig. 3.6, respectively. Time domain simulation results are, respectively, given in Figs. 3.10, 3.11, and 3.12 in which a sinusoidal peak input current signal with peak 50 μA at 1 MHz is separately applied to each of the ideal grounded resistor in Fig. 3.4, the ideal grounded capacitor in Fig. 3.5, and the ideal grounded inductor in Fig. 3.6.
40
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
Fig. 3.9 Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the inductor shown in Fig. 3.6
Fig. 3.10 Input current of the resistor in Fig. 3.4 and the corresponding output voltage
The ideal floating resistor, the ideal floating capacitor, and the ideal floating inductor are demonstrated in Figs. 3.13, 3.14, and 3.15, respectively. The ideal floating resistor, the ideal floating capacitor, and the ideal floating inductor in s domain are, respectively, expressed with the following matrix equations:
3.2
Passive Circuits
41
Fig. 3.11 Input current of the capacitor in Fig. 3.5 and the corresponding output voltage
Fig. 3.12 Input current of the inductor in Fig. 3.6 and the corresponding output voltage Fig. 3.13 An ideal floating resistor
I1 +
V_ 1
R
I2 +
V_ 2
42
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
Fig. 3.14 An ideal floating capacitor
I1
C
I2
+
+
V_ 2
V_1
Fig. 3.15 An ideal floating inductor
I1
L
I2
+
+
V1
V_ 2
_
1 -1
-1 1
V1 V2
ð3:12aÞ
I1 1 = sC I2 -1
-1 1
V1 V2
ð3:12bÞ
1 -1
-1 1
V1 V2
ð3:12cÞ
I1 1 = R I2
I1 1 = sL I2
Example 3.4 Find equivalent impedance (Zeq) of n impedances all in series. Solution 3.4 Zeq can be evaluated as n
Z eq =
ð3:13Þ
Zi i=1
Example 3.5 Find Zeq of m impedances all in parallel. Solution 3.5 Zeq can be computed by 1 = Z eq
m i=1
1 ) Z eq = Zi
1 m i=1
ð3:14Þ 1 Zi
Example 3.6 Find equivalent admittance (Yeq) of k admittances all in parallel. Solution 3.6 Yeq can be calculated as k
Y eq =
Yi i=1
ð3:15Þ
3.2
Passive Circuits
43
Example 3.7 Find Yeq of n admittances all in series. Solution 3.7 Yeq can be calculated below. 1 = Y eq
n
1 ) Y eq = Yi
i=1
1 n i=1
ð3:16Þ 1 Yi
In general, any impedances in the frequency domain can be defined as in the following: m
V ðωÞ ZðωÞ = in = I in ðωÞ
k=0 n i=0
ak ðjωÞk bi ðjωÞi
=
AR ðωÞ þ jAI ðωÞ BR ðωÞ þ jBI ðωÞ
ð3:17Þ
= jZðωÞjej∠ZðωÞ Here, AR(ω), AI(ω), BR(ω), and BI(ω) are function of real numbers. 180° ≤ ∠Z(ω) ≤ 180° is phase and |Z(ω)| is magnitude. They are, respectively, evaluated below. ∠Z ðωÞ = tan - 1
A I ð ωÞ B ð ωÞ - tan - 1 I AR ðωÞ B R ð ωÞ A2R ðωÞ þ A2I ðωÞ B2R ðωÞ þ B2I ðωÞ
jZ ðωÞj =
ð3:18aÞ ð3:18bÞ
From equation given in (3.17), the corresponding admittance can be expressed as Y ðω Þ =
I in ðωÞ 1 = V in ðωÞ Z ðωÞ
ð3:19Þ
Impedance and admittance selection suitable for integrated circuit (IC) fabrications is given in Table 3.2 in which only resistor and capacitor are considered. Table 3.2 Impedance and admittance selection suitable for IC processes
Z R 1/(sC) R/(1 + sCR) 1/(sC) + R 1 0
Y 1/R sC sC + 1/R sC/(1 + sCR) 0 1
Condition Resistor Capacitor Parallel resistor and capacitor Series resistor and capacitor Open circuit Short circuit
44
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
Any impedances and the corresponding admittances in s domain can be generally expressed below. m
V ðsÞ Z ðsÞ = in = I in ðsÞ
ai s i
i=0 n
bj s j
j=0
n
I ðsÞ 1 Y ðsÞ = = in = Z ðsÞ V in ðsÞ
j=0 m i=0
m
a = m bn
i=1 n j=1
bj sj ai si
ðs - zi Þ
n
b = n am
ð3:20aÞ
s - pj
j=1 m i=1
=
s - zj
=
s - pi
ð3:20bÞ
where ai (i = 1, 2, . . ., m) and bj ( j = 1, 2, . . ., n) are real numbers. zi and z/j refer to zeroes, and pj and p/i are poles. Also, they have the following relations: =
ð3:21aÞ
=
ð3:21bÞ
zj = pj ðj = 1, 2, 3, . . . , nÞ pi = zi ði = 1, 2, 3, . . . , mÞ
Note Real parts of all the poles and zeroes in Eq. (3.20) must be in the left half s plane for the stability [3]. Example 3.8 Find phase and magnitude of the impedance given below, where a, b, c, and d are all real numbers. Z in ðωÞ =
V in ðωÞ a þ jb = c þ jd I in ðωÞ
ð3:22Þ
Solution 3.8 Phase and magnitude of the impedance given in Eq. (3.22) are, respectively, found as follows: ∠Z in ðωÞ = Arc tan jZ in ðωÞj =
b d - Arc tan a c
V in ðωÞ = I in ðωÞ
a2 þ b 2 c2 þ d 2
ð3:23aÞ ð3:23bÞ
Example 3.9 Find phase and magnitude of the impedance of the RLC circuit in the frequency domain, which is demonstrated in Fig. 3.16. Solution 3.9 Impedance of the structure in Fig. 3.16 in the frequency domain can be computed as
3.2
Passive Circuits
45
Vin
Fig. 3.16 An RLC circuit
Iin L
Zin R
Z in ðωÞ = jωL þ R==
C
1 jωC
R 1 þ jωCR Rð1 - jωCRÞ = jωL þ 1 þ ω2 C 2 R2 R CR2 = þ jωðL Þ 1 þ ω2 C2 R2 1 þ ω2 C 2 R2 = jZ in ðωÞjej∠Z in ðωÞ
= jωL þ
ð3:24Þ
From equation given in (3.24), ∠Zin(ω) and |Zin(ω)| are, respectively, calculated below.
∠Z in ðωÞ = Arctan
jZ in ðωÞj =
R 1 þ ω2 C2 R2
CR2 1þω2 C 2 R2 R 1þω2 C 2 R2
ω L-
2
þ ω2 L -
CR2 1 þ ω2 C 2 R2
ð3:25aÞ 2
ð3:25bÞ
Example 3.10 Find the input impedance of the circuit in s domain, which is depicted in Fig. 3.17. Solution 3.10 Input impedance of the structure exhibited in Fig. 3.17 is evaluated below. Z in ðsÞ = R1 þ
1 1 þ sL1 þ 1 1 sC 1 þ sC 2 þ sL2 R2
ð3:26Þ
46
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
Vin
Fig. 3.17 A passive configuration
Iin R1 C1
Zin
L1
R2
3.3
C2
L2
RC and RL Circuits
RC circuit consisting of only one capacitor, resistor(s), and independent source (s) with no inductor is called as first-order topology. Also, RL circuit composed of only one inductor, resistor(s), and independent source(s) with no capacitor is called as first-order structure. As state variables, the capacitors possess voltages across their terminals, while the inductors have currents in them. These voltages and currents are considered as initial conditions for the capacitors and inductors, respectively. On the other hand, voltages/currents of the resistors can change abruptly. First-order RC and RL circuits for t ≥ 0 can be defined by τ
df ðt Þ þ f ðt Þ = K × input dt
ð3:27Þ
where K and the input are constants. f(t) can be capacitor current/voltage, inductor current/voltage, and resistor current/voltage. Also, τ is time constant and can be, respectively, defined for the capacitor and inductor as RC and L/R. From equation denoted in (3.27), f(t) is found as f ðt Þ = A þ Be - τ t
ð3:28Þ
where A and B are real numbers. From equation given in (3.28), A and B are, respectively, computed as follows: f ð 0Þ = A þ B ) B = f ð 0Þ - A
ð3:29aÞ
f ð 1Þ = A
ð3:29bÞ
Hence, from equations in (3.28) and (3.29), f(t) for t ≥ 0 can be rewritten as given below.
3.3 RC and RL Circuits
47
+ vR(t) - iC(t)
Fig. 3.18 A simple circuit containing one capacitor, one resistor, and one independent voltage source
R
Viu(t) +-
C
+ vC(t)
-
R
Fig. 3.19 Calculation of Req
Req=R
f ðt Þ = f ð1Þ þ ðf ð0Þ - f ð1ÞÞe - τ t
ð3:30Þ
Example 3.11 Find vC(t), vR(t), and iC(t) in the simple topology of Fig. 3.18, where Vi is constant positive voltage value and vC(0-) = 0 V. Solution 3.11 For the structure in Fig. 3.18, at time t = 0+, the capacitor is short circuit and the current passing through the capacitor is Vi/R. At time t = 1, the capacitor is open circuit and vC(1) = Vi. vC(t), vR(t), and iC(t) for t ≥ 0 are, respectively, evaluated below. vC ðt Þ = vC ð1Þ þ ðvC ð0Þ - vC ð1ÞÞe - τ = V i 1 - e - τ t
t
ð3:31aÞ
vR ð t Þ = V i - vC ð t Þ = V i - V i 1 - e - τ = V i e - τ t
i C ðt Þ = C
t dvC ðt Þ V = i e-τ Req dt
t
ð3:31bÞ ð3:31cÞ
Here, τ = ReqC. Req is calculated as follows: Independent voltage source is shortcircuited. Capacitor is taken, and it is looked at from the taken capacitor as seen from Fig. 3.19. The seen resistor is Req. In Example 3.11, Req = R. In Fig. 3.20, time domain simulation results for the circuit in Fig. 3.18 is demonstrated in which R = 1 kΩ, C = 50 pF, and Vi = 1 V are chosen. Also, τ is found as 50 ns. Example 3.12 For the topology of Fig. 3.21, find the current passing through the capacitor, iC(t) in which vC(0-) = 0 V, Vi is constant voltage value, and Ii is constant current value. Solution 3.12 Req is found such that the independent input voltage source is shortcircuited, while the independent input current source is open-circuited. Capacitor is taken, and it is looked at from the taken capacitor as seen from Fig. 3.22. Therefore,
48
3 Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
Fig. 3.20 Time domain capacitor current, capacitor voltage, and applied input voltage Fig. 3.21 A structure including one capacitor, two resistors, one independent voltage source, and one independent current source
Fig. 3.22 Evaluation of Req
R1 R2
Viu(t) +-
Iiu(t)
iC(t) C
R1 R2 Req=R1//R2
the seen resistor is Req = R1//R2. In the circuit of Fig. 3.21, iC(0) = Ii + Vi/R1 and iC(1) = 0. Therefore, iC(t) is computed as iC ðt Þ = iC ð1Þ þ ðiC ð0Þ - iC ð1ÞÞe - τ t V = Ii þ i e - τ R1 t
ð3:32Þ
3.3 RC and RL Circuits
49
Fig. 3.23 Time domain capacitor current, applied input current, and applied input voltage of the circuit given in Fig. 3.21 Fig. 3.24 A circuit using one voltage source, two resistors, and one capacitor
R1
vin(t) +-
+ vC(t) C
R2
+ vo(t)
-
Here, τ = ReqC. In Fig. 3.23, the time domain simulation results for the circuit in Fig. 3.21 are given, where R1 = 2 kΩ, R2 = 3 kΩ, C = 10 pF, Vi = 2 V, and Ii = 100 μA are taken. Therefore, Req = 1.2 kΩ and τ = 12 ns are found. Example 3.13 Find vC(t) and vo(t) of the circuit in Fig. 3.24 in which C = 50 pF, R1 = 1 kΩ, and R2 = 2 kΩ are chosen. Also, vC(0-) = 2 V is taken and applied piecewise constant input voltage, and vin(t) is exhibited in Fig. 3.25. Solution 3.13 For the circuit in Fig. 3.24, Req = R1 + R2 = 3 kΩ yielding τ = ReqC = 150 ns. There are two conditions for the circuit in Fig. 3.24. (i) The first condition, 0 ≤ t < 300 ns resulting in vC(0) = 2 V and vC(1) = 5 V. Hence, vC(t) is found below.
50
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
vin(t), V
Fig. 3.25 Applied piecewise input voltage
5 300
t, ns
-5
vC ðt Þ = vC ð1Þ þ ðvC ð0Þ - vC ð1ÞÞe - τ t = 5 - 3e - τ t
ð3:33Þ
From equation given in (3.33), vC(300- ns) is evaluated as vC ð300 - nsÞ = 5 - 3e - 2 ffi 4:594 V
ð3:34Þ
(ii) The second condition, t ≥ 300 ns resulting in vC(300 ns) ffi 4.954 V and vC(1) = -5 V. Thus, vC(t) is evaluated as follows: vC ðt Þ = vC ð1Þ þ ðvC ð300 nsÞ - vC ð1ÞÞe ffi - 5 þ 9:954e -
t - 300 ns τ
t - 300 ns 150 ns
ð3:35Þ
(i) The first condition, 0 ≤ t < 300 ns yielding vo(0) = (5 - 2) × 2/3 = 2 V and vo(1) = 0 V. In this case, vo(t) is calculated as in the following: vo ðt Þ = vo ð1Þ þ ðvo ð0Þ - vo ð1ÞÞe - τ t = 2e - 150 ns t
ð3:36Þ
Here, vo(300- ns) is computed as 0.27 V. However, vo(300+ ns) is independent from one in (3.36) and computed as vo ð300þ nsÞ = ð- 5 - 4:594Þ ×
2 ffi - 6:396 V 3
ð3:37Þ
(ii) The second condition, t ≥ 300 ns yielding vo(300+ ns) ffi -6.396 V and vo(1) = 0 V. As a result, vo(t) can be evaluated by vo ðt Þ = vo ð1Þ þ ðvo ð300 nsÞ - vo ð1ÞÞe = - 6:396e -
t - 300 ns 150 ns
t - 300 ns τ
ð3:38Þ
In Fig. 3.26, the time domain analysis results for the circuit of Fig. 3.24 are shown.
3.3 RC and RL Circuits
51
Fig. 3.26 Time domain simulation results for the topology of Fig. 3.24
R1
Fig. 3.27 A circuit employing one voltage source, two resistors, one capacitor, and one switch
+
Viu(t) -
R2 t=t0
+ C
vC(t)
-
Example 3.14 Find the capacitor voltage, vC(t) given in Fig. 3.27, where t0 = 40 ns, C = 10 pF, R1 = 2 kΩ, R2 = 3 kΩ, vC(0-) = 1 V, and Vi = 2.5 V are selected. Solution 3.14 There are two cases for the circuit in Fig. 3.27. (i) The first case, for 0 ≤ t < 40 ns, vC(0) = 1 V, vC(1) = 2.5 V, and Req = R1 = 2 kΩ. Consequently, τ1 = ReqC = 20 ns, and vC(t) is found below. vC ðt Þ = vC ð1Þ þ ðvC ð0Þ - vC ð1ÞÞe - τ t
= 2:5 - 1:5e - 20 ns t
From equation given in (3.39), vC(40- ns) is found as follows:
ð3:39Þ
52
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
Fig. 3.28 Time domain simulation results for the circuit in Fig. 3.27
vC ð40 - nsÞ = vC ð1Þ þ ðvC ð0Þ - vC ð1ÞÞe - τ t
= 2:5 - 1:5e - 2 ffi 2:297 V
ð3:40Þ
(ii) The second case, for t ≥ 40 ns, vC(40+ ns) = vC(40- ns) ffi 2.297 V, vC(1) = 1.5 V, and Req = R1//R2 = 1.2 kΩ. Therefore, τ2 = ReqC = 12 ns is obtained, and vC(t) is calculated by vC ðt Þ = vC ð1Þ þ ðvC ð40þ nsÞ - vC ð1ÞÞe = 1:5 þ ð2:297 - 1:5Þe = 1:5 þ 0:797e
t - 40 ns 12 ns
t - 40 ns 12 ns
ð3:41Þ
- t -1240nsns
The time domain simulation results for the circuit of Fig. 3.27 are depicted in Fig. 3.28. Example 3.15 Find the voltage across the capacitor, vC(t) in terms of the applied input current, iin(t) for the circuit of Fig. 3.29. Solution 3.15 vC(t) via iin(t) is found as dv ðt Þ 1 iC ðt Þ = iin ðt Þ = C C ) vC ðt Þ = dt C Equation (3.42) for t > 0 can be expressed by
t
iin ðτÞdτ -1
ð3:42Þ
3.3 RC and RL Circuits
53
Fig. 3.29 A circuit composed of one current source and one capacitor
iin(t)
C
+ vC(t)
-
Fig. 3.30 The time domain simulation results for the topology in Fig. 3.29
t
1 vC ðt Þ = vC ð0Þ þ C
iin ðτÞdτ
ð3:43Þ
0
The time domain simulation results for the topology in Fig. 3.29 are exhibited in Fig. 3.30 in which C = 25 pF and iin(t) = 100(μA)u(t) are taken. Note In the time domain simulation results for the topology in Fig. 3.29, a very large-valued parallel resistor is connected to the capacitor in the SPICE simulation. Example 3.16 A capacitor has a constant DC voltage across its two terminals, Vi. If its two terminals are short-circuited at t = 0, find its current. Solution 3.16 The voltage across the two terminals of the capacitor is given by vC ðt Þ = V i uð- t Þ Therefore, the current is evaluated as
ð3:44Þ
54
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
iL(t)
Fig. 3.31 A topology made up of an input current source, one resistor, and one inductor
iR(t)
Iiu(t)
Fig. 3.32 Computation of Req for the structure of Fig. 3.31
R
L
R Req=R
duð- t Þ dvC ðt Þ = CV i dt dt = - CV i δð - t Þ = - CV i δðt Þ
i C ðt Þ = C
ð3:45Þ
Example 3.17 Find the currents, iL(t) and iR(t) in Fig. 3.31, where Ii is a constant DC current and iL(0-) = 0 A. Solution 3.17 At time t = 0+, inductor behaves like an open circuit, i.e., iL(0+) = iL(0-) = 0 A. At time t = 1, inductor behaves like a short circuit; thus, iL(1) = Ii is obtained. In RL circuits, it is known that τ = L/Req. Req is evaluated as follows: Inductor is taken, the independent voltage source is short-circuited, and the independent current source is open-circuited. It is looked at from the taken inductor such that equivalent resistor is Req. For the circuit in Fig. 3.31, evaluation of Req is depicted in Fig. 3.32. iL(t) and iR(t) for t ≥ 0 are, respectively, found as iL ðt Þ = iL ð1Þ þ ðiL ð0Þ - iL ð1ÞÞe - τ t
= Ii 1 - e - τ t
i R ðt Þ = I i - i L ðt Þ = Iie - τ t
ð3:46aÞ ð3:46bÞ
The topology given in Fig. 3.31 is simulated through the SPICE program in which Ii = 100 μA, R = 1 kΩ, and L = 100 μH are selected. As a result, τ = 100 ns is found, and the time domain simulation results for the topology in Fig. 3.31 are demonstrated in Fig. 3.33.
3.3 RC and RL Circuits
55
Fig. 3.33 The time domain simulation results for the topology in Fig. 3.31
iL(t)
Fig. 3.34 A circuit with one voltage source and one inductor
vin(t) +-
L
Example 3.18 Find the inductor current, iL(t) in terms of vin(t) in Fig. 3.34. Solution 3.18 The inductor current, iL(t) in terms of vin(t) can be computed as di ðt Þ 1 vL ðt Þ = vin ðt Þ = L L ) iL ðt Þ = dt L
t
vin ðτÞdτ
ð3:47Þ
-1
From equation given in (3.47), iL(t) for t > 0 can be expressed by t
1 iL ðt Þ = iL ð0Þ þ L
vin ðτÞdτ 0
ð3:48Þ
56
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
Fig. 3.35 Time domain simulation results for the circuit given in Fig. 3.34
The simulation results for the topology in Fig. 3.34 are given in Fig. 3.35, where L = 50 μH and vin(t) = u(t) are taken. Note In the time domain simulation results for the topology in Fig. 3.34, a very small-valued series resistor is connected to the inductor in the SPICE simulation. Any RL or RC circuit in general form can be defined as [4, 5] Z = R þ jX
ð3:49Þ
Here, R is real part of the impedance, while X is imaginary part of the impedance. Also, R and X are real numbers. Therefore, quality factor (Q) of this first-order circuit can be expressed as follows: Q=
X R
ð3:50Þ
Example 3.19 Find impedance, phase, Q, and operating frequency of the series RL circuit depicted in Fig. 3.36. Solution 3.19 The impedance of this series RL topology in s domain is given below. Z s = r s þ sLs
ð3:51Þ
From equation denoted in (3.51), the impedance of the series RL circuit in the frequency domain is expressed by
3.3 RC and RL Circuits
57
Fig. 3.36 A series RL topology
Ls rs
Zs Fig. 3.37 A parallel RL topology
Lp
Rp
Zp Z s ðωÞ = r s þ jωLs
ð3:52Þ
where R = rs and X = ωLs. Then, Qs is evaluated below. Qs =
ωLs ωLs = rs rs
ð3:53Þ
If Qs ≥ 10 is chosen, the effect of rs can be ignored. Further, the circuit in Fig. 3.36 behaves like a lossless inductor at sufficiently high frequencies. In this case, operating frequency range can be found as in the following: Qs =
2πfLs ωLs 10 r s ≥ 10 ) ≥ 10 ) f ≥ × rs rs 2π Ls
ð3:54Þ
Phase and magnitude of the structure in Fig. 3.36 are, respectively, evaluated as ωLs rs
ð3:55aÞ
r 2s þ ω2 L2s
ð3:55bÞ
∠Z s ðωÞ = Arctan j Z s ð ωÞ j =
Example 3.20 Find impedance, phase, Q, and operating frequency of the parallel RL circuit given in Fig. 3.37. Solution 3.20 The impedance of this parallel RL circuit in s domain can be computed by
58
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
Z p = Rp == sLp sLp Rp = sLp þ Rp
ð3:56Þ
Equation of (3.56) in the frequency domain can be expressed as follows: jωLp Rp jωLp þ Rp
Z p ð ωÞ = =
ð3:57Þ
ω2 L2p Rp þ jωLp R2p ω2 L2p þ R2p
From equation given in (3.57), R and X are, respectively, found as R= X=
ω2 L2p Rp
ð3:58aÞ
ω2 L2p þ R2p ωLp R2p
ð3:58bÞ
ω2 L2p þ R2p
Hence, Qp is calculated below.
Qp =
X = R
ωLp R2p ω2 L2p þR2p ω2 L2p Rp ω2 L2p þR2p
=
Rp ωLp
ð3:59Þ
If Qp ≥ 10 is taken, the effect of Rp can be ignored. Hence, the parallel RL circuit of Fig. 3.37 can operate like a lossless inductor at sufficiently low frequencies. In this situation, the operating frequency range is calculated as Qp =
Rp Rp Rp 1 ≥ 10 ) ≥ 10 ) f ≤ 0:1 × × 2π Lp ωLp 2πfLp
ð3:60Þ
Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the circuit in Fig. 3.37 are, respectively, found by ∠Z p ðωÞ = Arctan
Z p ð ωÞ =
ω2 L2p Rp
2
Rp ωLp þ ωLp R2p
ω2 L2p þ R2p
ð3:61aÞ 2
ð3:61bÞ
3.3 RC and RL Circuits
59
Fig. 3.38 A series RC circuit
Cs rs
Zs Example 3.21 Find the impedance, phase, Q, and operating frequency of the series RC circuit exhibited in Fig. 3.38. Solution 3.21 The impedance of this circuit in s domain is computed as Zs =
1 þ rs sC s
ð3:62Þ
Equation of (3.62) in the frequency domain can be expressed as Z s ð ωÞ =
1 j þ rs = þ rs jωC s ωC s
ð3:63Þ
where R = rs and X = -1/(ωCs). In this case, Qs is found below. Qs =
1 - ωC 1 s = rs ωC s r s
ð3:64Þ
If Qs ≥ 10 is selected, the effect of rs can be ignored. Thus, this series RC topology works like a lossless capacitor at sufficiently low frequencies. In this situation, operating frequency range of this topology is found below. Qs =
1 1 1 1 ≥ 10 ) ≥ 10 ) f ≤ 0:1 × × ωCs r s 2πfC s r s 2π Cs r s
ð3:65Þ
Phase and magnitude of the series RC structure in Fig. 3.38 are, respectively, computed as ∠Z s ðωÞ = Arctan
1 - ωC s rs
jZ s ðωÞj =
= - Arctan 1 ω2 C 2s
þ r 2s
1 ωCs r s
ð3:66aÞ
ð3:66bÞ
Example 3.22 Find impedance, phase, Q, and operating frequency of the parallel RC circuit given in Fig. 3.39.
60
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
Solution 3.22 The impedance of this circuit in s domain is found as Zp =
Rp 1 ==Rp = sC p Rp þ 1 sCp
ð3:67Þ
The equation of (3.67) in the frequency domain can be expressed as in the following: Z p ð ωÞ = =
Rp jωC p Rp þ 1
ð3:68Þ
Rp - jωC p R2p ω2 C 2p R2p þ 1
From equation given in (3.68), R and X are, respectively, found as R= X=
Rp ω2 C 2p R2p þ 1
ð3:69aÞ
- ωC p R2p
ð3:69bÞ
ω2 C 2p R2p þ 1
Thus, Qp is evaluated by ωC R2
- ω2 C2 pR2 pþ1 X p p Qp = = ωC p Rp = Rp R 2 2 2
ð3:70Þ
ω C p Rp þ1
If Qp ≥ 10 is taken, the effect of Rp can be ignored. As a result, the parallel topology in Fig. 3.39 behaves like a lossless capacitor at sufficiently high frequencies. In this case, operating frequency range is computed below. Qp = ωCp Rp ≥ 10 ) 2πfC p Rp ≥ 10 ) f ≥
10 1 × 2π Cp Rp
ð3:71Þ
Fig. 3.39 A parallel RC circuit
Cp
Zp
Rp
3.4 RLC Circuits
61
Phase and magnitude of the parallel RC structure in Fig. 3.39 can be, respectively, found by
∠Z p ðωÞ = Arctan
Z p ð ωÞ =
3.4
- ωCp R2p ω2 C 2p R2p þ1 Rp ω2 C 2p R2p þ1
R2p þ ωC p R2p ω2 C 2p R2p
þ1
ð3:72aÞ
= - Arctan ωC p Rp
2
=
Rp
ð3:72bÞ
1 þ ω2 C 2p R2p
RLC Circuits
RLC circuits have at least one resistor and two energy storage elements, i.e., one capacitor and one inductor. If this circuit has no resistor, it is called as lossless. Example 3.23 Analyze the parallel RLC circuit in Fig. 3.40. Solution 3.23 Applying KCL, the following equation for the parallel RLC topology depicted in Fig. 3.40 is obtained: iin ðt Þ = iC ðt Þ þ iL ðt Þ þ iR ðt Þ
ð3:73Þ
Here, iin(t), iC(t), iL(t), and iR(t) are applied input current, capacitor current, inductor current, and resistor current, respectively. Also, v(t) in Fig. 3.40 is a capacitor voltage. On the other hand, inductor voltage of the circuit of Fig. 3.40 can be expressed as vð t Þ = L
diL ðt Þ dt
ð3:74Þ
The capacitor current and resistor current in terms of v(t) can be found below.
v(t)
Fig. 3.40 A parallel RLC circuit
iin(t)
C
L
iL(t)
R
62
3
i C ðt Þ = C iR ðt Þ =
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
dvðt Þ d 2 i ðt Þ = CL L2 dt dt
ð3:75aÞ
vðt Þ L diL ðt Þ = R R dt
ð3:75bÞ
If equations denoted in (3.75) are replaced into Equation (3.73), the following second-order differential equation is obtained: iin ðt Þ = iL ðt Þ þ
d 2 i ðt Þ L diL ðt Þ þ CL L2 R dt dt
ð3:76Þ
Rearranging the equation in (3.76), the following equation is obtained: d2 iL ðtÞ 1 1 1 diL ðtÞ þ iin ðtÞ = þ i ðtÞ CL CL L CR dt dt 2
ð3:77Þ
The equation of (3.77) simplifies as ω20 iin ðt Þ =
d2 iL ðt Þ ω0 diL ðt Þ þ ω20 iL ðt Þ þ Q dt dt 2
ð3:78Þ
where ω0 and Q are, respectively, found by ω0 = Q=R
1 LC
ð3:79aÞ
C L
ð3:79bÞ
The characteristic expression of the differential equation given in (3.78) can be evaluated as below. m2 þ
ω0 m þ ω20 = 0 Q
ð3:80Þ
Thus, homogeneous solution of the second-order differential equation indicated in (3.78) can be calculated by using the roots. m1,2 = -
ω0 ± 2Q
ω20 - ω20 4Q2
ð3:81Þ
One observes from equation in (3.81) that there are three cases that are explained as follows:
3.4 RLC Circuits
63
(i) m1 and m2 are real and distinct.
m1 = -
ω0 2Q
ω20 - ω20 4Q2
ð3:82aÞ
m2 = -
ω0 þ 2Q
ω20 - ω20 4Q2
ð3:82bÞ
In this case, the overdamped condition is met as given below. ω20 1 - ω20 > 0 ) Q < 2 2 4Q
ð3:83Þ
(ii) m1 and m2 are real and equal. m1 = m2 = -
ω0 2Q
ð3:84Þ
In this case, the critically damped condition is met as follows: ω20 1 - ω20 = 0 ) Q = 2 2 4Q
ð3:85Þ
(iii) m1 and m2 are complex conjugate.
m1 = -
ω2 ω0 - j ω20 - 02 2Q 4Q
ð3:86aÞ
m2 = -
ω2 ω0 þ j ω20 - 02 2Q 4Q
ð3:86bÞ
In this case, the underdamped condition is met as in the following: ω20 1 - ω20 < 0 ) Q > 2 4Q2
ð3:87Þ
On the other hand, a particular solution depends on the form of the applied input, iin(t). After specifying form of iin(t) such as δ(t), u(t), r(t), exponential function, sinusoidal function, etc., the particular solution can be obtained. Then, a complete response for the parallel RLC circuit in Fig. 3.40 can be found by adding homogeneous and particular solutions.
64
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
Fig. 3.41 A series RLC circuit
i(t)
R +
vin(t) -
+ vR(t)
_
L +
vL(t)
_
C
+
v_C(t)
Note Initial conditions of the capacitor and inductor are considered in the complete response. Example 3.24 Analyze the series RLC circuit in Fig. 3.41. Solution 3.24 Applying KVL, the following equation for the series RLC structure depicted in Fig. 3.41 is obtained: vin ðt Þ = vR ðt Þ þ vL ðt Þ þ vC ðt Þ
ð3:88Þ
where vin(t), vR(t), vL(t), and vC(t) exhibit applied input voltage, resistor voltage, inductor voltage, and capacitor voltage, respectively. Further, i(t) in Fig. 3.41 is a capacitor current. Apart from these, the capacitor current of the circuit of Fig. 3.41 can be given by i ðt Þ = C
dvC ðt Þ dt
ð3:89Þ
The inductor voltage and resistor voltage in terms of i(t) can be found below. vL ð t Þ = L
diðt Þ d 2 vC ð t Þ = CL dt dt 2
vR ðt Þ = Riðt Þ = CR
dvC ðt Þ dt
ð3:90aÞ ð3:90bÞ
If equations in (3.90) are replaced into Eq. (3.88), the following second-order differential equation is obtained: vin ðt Þ = CR
d 2 vC ð t Þ dvC ðt Þ þ CL þ vC ð t Þ dt dt 2
ð3:91Þ
Rearranging the equation in (3.91), the following equation is obtained: d 2 vC ðt Þ R dvC ðt Þ 1 1 þ þ vin ðt Þ = vC ð t Þ 2 dt L CL CL dt The equation given in (3.92) simplifies as
ð3:92Þ
3.4 RLC Circuits
65
Fig. 3.42 A series LC circuit
Ls Cs
Zs ω20 vin ðt Þ =
d2 vC ðt Þ ω0 dvC ðt Þ þ ω20 vC ðt Þ þ Q dt dt 2
ð3:93Þ
where ω0 and Q are, respectively, found as ω0 = Q=
1 R
1 LC
ð3:94aÞ
L C
ð3:94bÞ
The similar calculations can be performed for the series RLC circuit, which is made for the parallel RLC topology. On the other hand, any second-order series RLC circuit can be defined as given below. Z=
s2 þ s ωQ0 þ ω20 að s Þ
ð3:95Þ
From equation given in (3.95), BW based on ω0 and Q is evaluated as follows: BW =
ω0 Q
ð3:96Þ
Example 3.25 Find phase and impedance of the series LC circuit in Fig. 3.42. Solution 3.25 The series LC circuit demonstrated in Fig. 3.42 has the following impedance:
Z s = sLs þ
s × sLs þ sC1 s 1 = sC s s×1
From equation given in (3.97), Zs simplifies as given below.
ð3:97Þ
66
3
Zs =
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
s2 Ls þ C1s ÷ Ls
=
s ÷ Ls
s2 þ Ls1Cs s Ls
ð3:98Þ
From equation in (3.98), ω0 and Q are, respectively, found as ω0 =
1 Ls C s
ð3:99aÞ
Q=1
ð3:99bÞ
Impedance of the series LC circuit demonstrated in Fig. 3.42 in the frequency domain can be found as follows: Z s ðωÞ =
- ω2
1 Ls C s
jω Ls
ð3:100Þ
Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the topology in Fig. 3.42 for 1/(√(LsCs)) ≥ ω > 0 are, respectively, evaluated as ∠Z s ðωÞ = - 90 ° jZ s ðωÞj =
1 Ls C s
- ω2 ω Ls
ð3:101aÞ ð3:101bÞ
Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the circuit in Fig. 3.42 for ω > 1/ (√(LsCs)) are, respectively, computed by ∠Z s ðωÞ = 90 ° jZ s ðωÞj =
ω2 ω Ls
1 Ls C s
ð3:102aÞ ð3:102bÞ
Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the circuit given in Fig. 3.42 are exhibited in Fig. 3.43, where Ls = 100 μH and Cs = 100 pF yielding f0 ffi 1.59 MHz are taken. Additionally, simulations are performed through the SPICE program. One observes from Fig. 3.43 that the phase response varies from -90° to 90° as the frequency changes from zero to infinity. Example 3.26 Find phase and impedance of the parallel LC circuit in Fig. 3.44. Solution 3.26 Impedance of the parallel LC circuit demonstrated in Fig. 3.44 is evaluated below.
3.4 RLC Circuits
67
Fig. 3.43 Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the circuit given in Fig. 3.42 Fig. 3.44 A parallel LC topology Cp
Lp
Zp
s × sLp × sC1 p sLp × sC1 p 1 Z p = sLp == = = sCp sLp þ sC1 s × sLp þ sC1 p p
ð3:103Þ
The equation in (3.103) simplifies as
Zp =
sLp Cp
÷ Lp
s2 Lp þ C1p ÷ Lp
=
s Cp
s2 þ Lp1Cp
ð3:104Þ
Similarly, from equation in (3.104), ω0 and Q are, respectively, found as ω0 =
1 Lp C p
Q=1
ð3:105aÞ ð3:105bÞ
68
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
A parallel LC circuit in Fig. 3.44 in the frequency domain has the following impedance: Z p ðωÞ =
jω Cp 1 Lp C p
- ω2
ð3:106Þ
Phase and magnitude of the parallel LC circuit in Fig. 3.44 for 1/(√(LpCp)) ≥ ω > 0, are respectively, computed as ∠Z p ðωÞ = 90 ° Z p ðωÞ =
ω Cp 1 Lp C p
- ω2
ð3:107aÞ ð3:107bÞ
Phase and magnitude of the parallel LC circuit in Fig. 3.44 for ω > 1/(√(LpCp)) are, respectively, calculated by ∠Z p ðωÞ = - 90 ° Z p ðωÞ =
ω Cp
ω2 -
1 Lp C p
ð3:108aÞ ð3:108bÞ
Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the circuit in Fig. 3.44 are exhibited in Fig. 3.45 in which L = 100 μH and C = 100 pF yielding f0 ffi 1.59 MHz are chosen. Moreover, simulations are performed via the SPICE program.
Fig. 3.45 Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the topology in Fig. 3.44
3.4 RLC Circuits
69
Fig. 3.46 A series RLC circuit
Ls rs
Zs
Cs
It is observed from Fig. 3.45 that the phase response varies from 90° to -90° as the frequency changes from zero to infinity. Example 3.27 Find impedance of the series RLC circuit in Fig. 3.46. Solution 3.27 Impedance of the series RLC circuit in Fig. 3.46 is found as follows: 1 s × sLs þ þ rs sC s 1 þ rs = Z s = sLs þ sC s s×1 1 s2 Ls þ sr s þ ÷ Ls s 2 þ s r s þ 1 Cs Ls Ls C s = = s s ÷ Ls Ls
ð3:109Þ
From equation indicated in (3.109), ω0 and ω0/Q are, respectively, computed by 1 Ls C s ω0 r = s Q Ls
ð3:110aÞ
ω0 =
ð3:110bÞ
From equations in (3.110), Q is evaluated as Q=
ω0 Ls 1 = rs rs
Ls Cs
ð3:111Þ
Impedance of the series RLC circuit in Fig. 3.46 in the frequency domain is given by Z s ð ωÞ =
jω Lrss þ Ls1Cs - ω2 jω Ls
ð3:112Þ
Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the series RLC circuit in Fig. 3.46 in the frequency domain are, respectively, calculated below.
70
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
Fig. 3.47 Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the circuit shown in Fig. 3.46
∠Z s ðωÞ = - 90o þ Arctan
jZ s ðωÞj =
1 Ls C s
- ω2
2
ω Lrss 1 Ls C s
- ω2
þ ω Lrss
ð3:113aÞ
2
ω Ls
ð3:113bÞ
Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the circuit in Fig. 3.46 are demonstrated in Fig. 3.47 in which rs = 1 kΩ, Ls = 100 μH, and Cs = 100 pF resulting in f0 ffi 1.59 MHz and Q = 1 are selected. Also, simulations are made via the SPICE program. One sees from Fig. 3.46 that the phase response varies from -90° to 90°as the frequency changes from zero to infinity. Example 3.28 Find impedance of the parallel RLC circuit depicted in Fig. 3.48. Solution 3.28 Impedance of the parallel RLC circuit depicted in Fig. 3.48 can be found as given below. Z p = sLp ==
1 ==Rp sC p
The impedance given in Eq. (3.114) can be easily evaluated as
ð3:114Þ
3.4 RLC Circuits
71
Fig. 3.48 A parallel RLC structure.
Cp
Rp
Lp
Zp
Zp =
1 = Yp
1 1 sLp
þ R1p þ sC p
1×
=
1 sLp
s Cp
þ R1p þ sC p ×
s Cp
ð3:115Þ
The impedance in Eq. (3.115) simplifies as Zp =
s2 þ
s Cp s Rp1Cp
þ Lp1Cp
ð3:116Þ
From the equation in (3.116), ω0 and ω0/Q are, respectively, evaluated as ω0 =
1 Lp C p
ð3:117aÞ
1 ω0 = Q Rp C p
ð3:117bÞ
Similarly, from the equations given in (3.117), Q is found below. Q = ω0 Rp C p = Rp
Cp Lp
ð3:118Þ
Substituting s = jω into (3.116), the following impedance in the frequency domain can be obtained as Z p ð ωÞ =
jω Cp
jω Rp1Cp þ Lp1Cp - ω2
ð3:119Þ
Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the circuit depicted in Fig. 3.48 are, respectively, evaluated as in the following:
72
3
Passive Circuit Elements and Their Analysis
Fig. 3.49 Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the circuit shown in Fig. 3.48
∠Z p ðωÞ = 90 ° - Arctan
ω Rp C p 1 Lp C p
ð3:120aÞ
- ω2
ω Cp
Z p ð ωÞ = 1 Lp C p
- ω2
2
þ
ω Rp C p
2
ð3:120bÞ
Phase and magnitude of the impedance of the circuit in Fig. 3.48 are demonstrated in Fig. 3.49, where Rp = 1 kΩ, Lp = 100 μH, and Cp = 100 pF yielding f0 ffi 1.59 MHz and Q = 1 are taken. Further, simulations are made through the SPICE program. It is seen from Fig. 3.49 that the phase response varies from 90° to -90° as the frequency changes from zero to infinity.
References 1. J.A. Svoboda, R.C. Dorf, Dorf’s Introduction to Electric Circuits, Global edition. (Wiley, 2018) 2. J.W. Nilsson, S. Riedel, Electric Circuits, Global edition, 11th ed. (Pearson, 2018) 3. L.O. Chua, C.A. Desoer, E.S. Kuh, Linear and Nonlinear Circuits (McGraw-Hill, 1987) 4. R.J. Cameron, C.M. Kudsia, Microwave Filters for Communication Systems, 2nd edn. (Wiley, 2018) 5. D.M. Pozar, Microwave Engineering, 3rd edn. (Wiley, 2005)
Chapter 4
Main Transfer Functions of the Circuits
4.1
Definition of the Filter Transfer Function
If the input is x(t) and the corresponding output is y(t) in a LTI system, the filter transfer function (FTF) of this system is defined as [1] m
Y ðsÞ H ðsÞ = = X ð sÞ
i=0 n j=0
ai s i ð4:1Þ bj
sj
Here, ai (i = 0, 1, 2, . . ., m) and bj ( j = 0, 1, 2, . . ., n) are real numbers. Moreover, X(s) and Y(s) represent Laplace transform of x(t) and y(t), respectively. In this section, FTFs can be divided into four categories depending on the applied input and the corresponding output whether they are current and/or voltage. These FTFs called as voltage-mode (VM), current-mode (CM), transimpedance-mode (TIM), and transadmittance-mode (TAM) are, respectively, depicted in Figs. 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, and 4.4. Apart from these, these FTFs are obtained from the various combinations of R, L, and C.
4.1.1
VM FTF
A VM FTF has ideally infinite input impedance and zero output impedance. The VM FTF in Fig. 4.1 is found as [2, 3] H V ðsÞ =
V out ðsÞ V in ðsÞ
© The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2024 E. Yuce, S. Minaei, Passive and Active Circuits by Example, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6_4
ð4:2Þ
73
74
4
Main Transfer Functions of the Circuits
Fig. 4.1 Block diagram of a VM filter
+ V_in
Iout
Fig. 4.2 Block diagram of a CM filter
Iin
Fig. 4.3 Block diagram of a TIM filter
Iin
HI
+ Vout _
HZ
Iout
Fig. 4.4 Block diagram of a TAM filter
4.1.2
+ Vout _
HV
+ Vin _
HY
CM FTF
A CM FTF has ideally zero input impedance and infinite output impedance. The CM FTF in Fig. 4.2 is given by H I ðsÞ =
4.1.3
I out ðsÞ I in ðsÞ
ð4:3Þ
TIM FTF
A TIM FTF possesses ideally zero input and output impedances. The TIM FTF in Fig. 4.3 is expressed as follows: H Z ðsÞ =
V out ðsÞ = Rm I in ðsÞ
ð4:4Þ
4.2
First-Order VM FTFs
4.1.4
75
TAM FTF
A TAM FTF possesses ideally infinite input and output impedances. The TAM FTF in Fig. 4.4 is expressed below. H Y ðsÞ =
4.2
I out ðsÞ = Gm V in ðsÞ
ð4:5Þ
First-Order VM FTFs
Transfer functions (TFs) of the first-order VM filters can be divided into three categories, low-pass filter (LPF), high-pass filter (HPF), and all-pass filter (APF) TFs.
4.2.1
VM LPF TFs
In this subsection, VM LPF TFs based on the various combinations of R, L, and C are investigated. Example 4.1 Draw the circuit, and find the TF of a first-order VM LPF based on RC. Solution 4.1 The first-order VM LPF based on RC is demonstrated in Fig. 4.5 and has the following TF: 1 V out ðsÞ sC = H LP ðsÞ = 1 V in ðsÞ þR sC 1 1 ω0 RC = = = 1 s þ ω0 sCR þ 1 sþ RC
Fig. 4.5 A first-order VM LPF based on RC
ð4:6Þ
R
+ Vin _
+ Vout C _
76
4
Main Transfer Functions of the Circuits
where ω0 = 1/(RC) is called as angular pole frequency. Further, equation of (4.6) in the frequency domain can be written as H LP ðωÞ =
ω0 jω þ ω0
ð4:7Þ
= jH LP ðωÞjej∠H LP ðωÞ Phase and gain of the TF in Eq. (4.7) are, respectively, evaluated as ∠H LP ðωÞ = - tan - 1 jH LP ðωÞj =
ω ω0
ð4:8aÞ
ω0 ω2 þ ω20
ð4:8bÞ
Gain of the TF in Eq. (4.8b) can be written in dB as follows: 20 logjH LP ðωÞj = 20 log
ω0 ω2 þ ω20
= 20 logðω0 Þ - 20 log
ð4:9Þ
ω2 þ ω20
= 20 logðω0 Þ - 10 log ω2 þ ω20 One observes from Eq. (4.9) that if ω > ω0 is selected, the gain of the LPF decreases with slope of -20 dB/decade. Example 4.2 Draw the circuit, and find the TF of a first-order VM LPF based on RL. Solution 4.2 The first-order VM LPF based on RL is exhibited in Fig. 4.6 and has the following TF: V out ðsÞ R = sL þ R V in ðsÞ R ω0 = L = R s þ ω0 sþ L Here, ω0 = R/L is called as angular pole frequency. H LP ðsÞ =
Fig. 4.6 A first-order VM LPF based on RL
ð4:10Þ
L + V_in
+
R
Vout _
4.2
First-Order VM FTFs
77
Fig. 4.7 A first-order VM HPF based on RC
C +
V_in
4.2.2
+
R
V_out
VM HPF TFs
In this subsection, VM HPFs based on various combinations of R, C, and L are investigated. Example 4.3 Draw the circuit, and find the TF of a first-order VM HPF based on RC. Solution 4.3 The first-order VM HPF based on RC is shown in Fig. 4.7 and has the following TF: V out ðsÞ R = 1 V in ðsÞ þR sC sCR s s = = = 1 sCR þ 1 s þ ω0 sþ RC
H HP ðsÞ =
ð4:11Þ
Similarly, ω0 = 1/(RC) is found. TF given in Eq. (4.11) in the frequency domain can be expressed as H HP ðωÞ =
jω jω þ ω0
= jH HP ðωÞjej∠H HP ðωÞ
ð4:12Þ
Phase and gain of the HPF TF are, respectively, calculated as given below. ∠H HP ðωÞ = 90o - tan - 1 jH HP ðωÞj =
ω ω0
ω þ ω20
ð4:13aÞ ð4:13bÞ
ω2
Gain of the TF in Eq. (4.13b) can be written in dB as follows: 20 logjH HP ðωÞj = 20 log
ω ω2 þ ω20
= 20 logðωÞ - 20 log
ω2 þ ω20
= 20 logðωÞ - 10 log ω2 þ ω20
ð4:14Þ
78
4
Main Transfer Functions of the Circuits
Fig. 4.8 A first-order VM HPF based on RL
R +
V_in
+
L
V_out
It is seen from equation given in (4.14) that for ω > ω0, the gain is 0 dB. Example 4.4 Draw the circuit, and find the TF of a first-order VM HPF based on RL. Solution 4.4 The first-order VM HPF based on RL is given in Fig. 4.8 and has the following TF: V out ðsÞ sL = sL þ R V in ðsÞ s s = = R s þ ω0 sþ L
H LP ðsÞ =
ð4:15Þ
Likewise, ω0 = R/L.
4.2.3
VM APF TFs
VM APFs have different realizations. In the following, a floating output realization of the first-order APF is given. Example 4.5 Find the TF of the first-order VM APF given in Fig. 4.9. Solution 4.5 First-order VM APF in Fig. 4.9 for R2 = R1 can provide the following TF: H AP ðsÞ =
V out ðsÞ 1 1 = 2 1 þ sCR V in ðsÞ
s 11 1 - sCR 1 ω0 =- × =- × 2 1 þ sCR 2 1þ s ω0
ð4:16Þ
Here, ω0 = 1/(RC). From Eq. (4.16), TF in the frequency domain can be written as
4.3
First-Order CM FTFs
79
Fig. 4.9 First-order VM APF based on RC
+
V_in R
R1 + Vout
_ C
R2
H AP ðωÞ = jH AP ðωÞjej∠H AP ðωÞ
ð4:17Þ
where ∠HAP(ω) and |HAP(ω)| are, respectively, calculated as ∠H AP ðωÞ = 180o - 2 tan - 1 jω 1 1 1 - ω0 = × jH AP ðωÞj = 2 2 1 þ jω ω0
ω ω0
12 þ 1 þ 2
ð4:18aÞ 2
ω ω0
ω ω0
2
=
1 2
ð4:18bÞ
The circuit in Fig. 4.9 has inverting APF responses. On the other hand, one can change the polarity of the output in Fig. 4.9 to obtain a non-inverting first-order VM all-pass filter. Thus, gain does not change, while the phase becomes below. ∠H AP ðωÞ = - 2 tan - 1
4.3
ω ω0
ð4:19Þ
First-Order CM FTFs
Similarly, first-order CM FTFs can be obtained from various combinations of R, L, and C. Example 4.6 Find the TFs of the RC-based first-order CM filter demonstrated in Fig. 4.10. Solution 4.6 In order to analyze this RC circuit, an arbitrary auxiliary node called as Vtest is used. By applying KCL, the following equation is obtained:
80
4
Main Transfer Functions of the Circuits
Fig. 4.10 A first-order CM filter based on RC
Vtest
Iin
1 þ sC R
I in ðsÞ = V test
R
C
ILP
IHP
ð4:20Þ
Thus, Vtest can be easily evaluated as follows: V test =
R I sCR þ 1 in
ð4:21Þ
From equation in (4.21), a first-order TIM LPF TF is found as H ðsÞ =
V test R = I in sCR þ 1
ð4:22Þ
By using Eq. (4.21), low-pass current (ILP) and high-pass one (IHP) are, respectively, evaluated as I LP =
V test 1 = I R sCR þ 1 in
I HP = sCV test =
sCR I sCR þ 1 in
ð4:23aÞ ð4:23bÞ
From equations given in (4.23), the following LPF and HPF TFs are, respectively, computed by 1 I LP = sCR þ 1 I in
ð4:24aÞ
sCR I HP = I in sCR þ 1
ð4:24bÞ
The angular pole frequency of this filter is calculated as 1/(CR). Example 4.7 Find the output currents of the RL-based first-order CM filter shown in Fig. 4.11. Solution 4.7 In order to analyze this RL circuit, Vtest is used. By applying KCL, the following equation is obtained: I in = V test Therefore, Vtest can be easily evaluated by
1 1 þ R sL
ð4:25Þ
4.4
Second-Order VM FTFs
81
Fig. 4.11 A first-order CM filter based on RL
Vtest
Iin
V test =
sR I in s þ RL
L
R
ILP
IHP
ð4:26Þ
From equation indicated in (4.26), a first-order TIM HPF TF is found as H ðsÞ =
V test ðsÞ sR = I in ðsÞ s þ RL
ð4:27Þ
By using Eq. (4.26), ILP and IHP are, respectively, calculated as I LP =
R V test = L R I in sL sþL
ð4:28aÞ
I HP =
s V test I in = R s þ RL
ð4:28bÞ
The angular pole frequency of the filter is calculated as R/L.
4.4
Second-Order VM FTFs
Example 4.8 Find the output voltage of the second-order three-input single-output universal filter based on RLC depicted in Fig. 4.12. Solution 4.8 This filter is analyzed by using KCL as below. V - V2 V 1 - V out = out þ ðV out - V 3 ÞsC sL R
ð4:29Þ
Organization of the equation in (4.29), output voltage, Vout depending on the applied input voltages is evaluated as V out =
1 1 s2 V 3 þ s RC V 2 þ LC V1 1 1 2 s þ s RC þ LC
From equation given in (4.30), ω0 and Q are, respectively, computed by
ð4:30Þ
82
4
Main Transfer Functions of the Circuits
Fig. 4.12 A second-order three-input single-output universal filter based on RCL
V1 V2 V3
L
R C
1 ω0 = p LC Q=R
Vout
ð4:31aÞ
C = ω0 RC L
ð4:31bÞ
In Eq. (4.30), Vout is obtained as follows: If V2 = V3 = 0 and V1 = Vin are chosen, an LPF response is obtained. If V1 = V3 = 0 and V2 = Vin are chosen, a BPF response is obtained. If V1 = V2 = 0 and V3 = Vin are chosen, an HPF response is obtained. If V1 = V3 = Vin and V2 = -Vin are chosen, an APF response is obtained. The voltage, -Vin can be easily obtained by using a unity gain inverting amplifier. 5. If V1 = V3 = Vin and V2 = 0 are chosen, an NF response is obtained.
1. 2. 3. 4.
Note Gains of the LPF, BPF, HPF, APF, and NF in Fig. 4.12 are unity. Example 4.9 Find the output voltages Vout1 and Vout2 of the circuit shown in Fig. 4.13. Which filter responses are realized? Solution 4.9 Responses of the second-order single-input two-output filter depicted in Fig. 4.13 can be, respectively, evaluated by
V out1 =
=
1 þ sL sC sL þ R þ s2 þ
s2 þ
1 sC
1 LC
sR 1 þ L LC
V in =
V in
1 þ s2 LC V þ sCR þ 1 in
s2 LC
ð4:32aÞ
4.4
Second-Order VM FTFs
83
Fig. 4.13 A second-order single-input two-output filter
C
R
+ Vin _
C
Fig. 4.14 A second-order single-input single-output filter
L
V out2 =
sL sL þ R þ
1 sC
V in =
s2 LC
Vout2 _
L
+
+ Vin _
=
+
+ Vout1 _
R
Vout _
s2 LC V þ sCR þ 1 in ð4:32bÞ
s2 V sR 1 in s2 þ þ L LC
So, NF and HPF responses are obtained from Vout1 and Vout2, respectively. From equations denoted in (4.32), ω0 and Q are, respectively, calculated as 1 ω0 = p LC
ð4:33aÞ
1 R
ð4:33bÞ
Q=
L C
Example 4.10 Find the output voltage Vout of the circuit shown in Fig. 4.14. Which filter response is realized? Solution 4.10 Response of the second-order single-input single-output BPF shown in Fig. 4.14 can be computed as V out =
sR R V in = 2 sRL V in 1 1 sL þ R þ sC s þ L þ LC
ð4:34Þ
From equation given in (4.34), TF of the circuit is calculated as in the following: H ðsÞ =
sR V out ðsÞ = 2 sRL 1 V in ðsÞ s þ L þ LC
So, a BPF response is obtained from the output, Vout.
ð4:35Þ
84
4
Main Transfer Functions of the Circuits L
R
Fig. 4.15 A second-order single-input single-output filter
+
+
Vin _
C
Vout _
Example 4.11 Find the output voltage, Vout of the circuit shown in Fig. 4.15. Which filter response is realized? Solution 4.11 Response of the second-order single-input single-output filter shown in Fig. 4.15 can be computed as
V out =
1 sC sL þ R þ
1 sC
V in =
1 C s2 L þ sR þ
1 C
V in
1 LC = V sR 1 in s2 þ þ L LC
ð4:36Þ
From equation given in (4.36), TF of the filter is calculated as follows: H ðsÞ =
1 V out ðsÞ = 2 LC 1 V in ðsÞ s þ sR L þ LC
ð4:37Þ
So, an LPF response is obtained from the output Vout.
4.5
Second-Order CM FTFs
Example 4.12 Find the output currents of the second-order CM universal filter based on RLC demonstrated in Fig. 4.16. Solution 4.12 Vtest can be easily evaluated by using the following equation: I in = V test
1 1 þ þ sC sL R
ð4:38Þ
From equation given in (4.38), Vtest is found by V test =
s2
s C1 I 1 1 in þ s RC þ LC
ð4:39Þ
4.5
Second-Order CM FTFs
85
Vtest
Fig. 4.16 A second-order single-input three-output CM universal filter
Iin
L
R
C
ILP
IBP
IHP
Vtest
Fig. 4.17 A second-order single-input single-output CM LPF
Iin
R
L
C
Iout
LPF, BPF, and HPF currents by using Vtest are, respectively, calculated as follows: 1
I LP =
V test = LC I in sL DðsÞ
ð4:40aÞ
I BP =
s 1 V test = RC I in R DðsÞ
ð4:40bÞ
s2 I DðsÞ in
ð4:40cÞ
1 1 þ RC LC
ð4:41Þ
I HP = V test sC = Here, D(s) is given as DðsÞ = s2 þ s
By using LPF, BPF, and HPF currents, NF and APF currents can be, respectively, obtained as I NF = I LP þ I HP
ð4:42aÞ
I AP = I LP - I BP þ I HP
ð4:42bÞ
Example 4.13 Find the output current of the second-order CM LPF based on RLC exhibited in Fig. 4.17. Solution 4.13 Vtest can be easily evaluated by using the following equation: I in = V test sC þ
I ðsL þ RÞ 1 I in ) V test = = 2 in 1 sL þ R sC þ sLþR s CL þ sCR þ 1
ð4:43Þ
86
4
Main Transfer Functions of the Circuits
From equation in (4.43), TF of the LPF is computed below. H ðsÞ =
4.6
1
I out V test LC = = 1 I in I in ðsL þ RÞ s2 þ sR L þ LC
ð4:44Þ
High-Order VM BPF TF
A fourth-order single-input single-output VM BPF is demonstrated in Fig. 4.18 [4]. In this filter, Q1 = ω01R1C1, Q2 = ω02R2C2, ω01 = 1/√((L1+L3)C1), and ω02 = 1/ √((L2+L3)C2). If the passive elements are taken as C1 = C2 = 100 pF, L1 = 10.83 μH, L2 = 23.14 μH, L3 = 5 μH, R1 = 2 kΩ, and R2 = 2 kΩ then f01 ffi 4 MHz, f02 ffi 3 MHz, Q1 ffi 5.03, and Q2 ffi 3.77 are found. Simulation results for this filter are plotted in Fig. 4.19. One observes from Fig. 4.19 that phase response varies from 90° to -270° as the frequency changes from zero to infinity.
+ Vin _
L2
L1
R1 C1
L3
R2
C2
+ Vout _
Fig. 4.18 A fourth-order single-input single-output VM BPF
Fig. 4.19 Phase and gain of the fourth-order single-input single-output VM BPF in Fig. 4.18
References
87
References 1. A.V. Oppenheim, A.S. Willsky, S.H. Nawab, Signals and Systems, Pearson New International Edition. (Pearson Education Limited, Harlow, 2013) 2. A.B. Williams, Analog Filter and Circuit Design Handbook (McGraw Hill Professional, 2013) 3. R. Schaumann, M.E.V. Valkenburg, Design of Analog Filters (Oxford University Press, 2001) 4. M. Dogan, E. Yuce, S. Minaei, M. Sagbas, Synthetic transformer design using commercially available active components. Circuits Syst. Sign. Process. 39(8), 3770–3786 (2020)
Chapter 5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
5.1
Practical Operational Amplifiers
Electrical symbol of the operational amplifier (OA) is depicted in Fig. 5.1. OA has three terminals, non-inverting (+ terminal), inverting (- terminal), and output ones. In addition, it has two symmetrical DC supply voltages, VEE and VCC, where VEE = -VCC [1–4]. Output voltage, Vout, of the OA is evaluated as V out = AðV þ - V - Þ
ð5:1Þ
Here, A is open loop gain of the OA. Furthermore, A is frequency-dependent and can be modeled by using a single pole model as follows: A=
A0 1 þ fjf
ð5:2Þ
b
where A0 is DC open loop gain, while fb is -3 dB frequency. A0 takes values between 104 and 106 practically. Due to high values of A0, OA-based circuits are designed by using feedback. Rated voltages are maximum/minimum voltages at the output of the OA. These voltages are always lower than supply voltages of the OA in magnitude. For example, if VCC = -VEE = 12 V are taken, rated voltages are about Vr+ = 9 V and Vr- = -9 V. In other words, Vr+ < VCC and Vr- > VEE. Moreover, Vout and output current Iout are, respectively, expressed as V r - ≤ V out ≤ V rþ
ð5:3aÞ
jI out j ≤ I out, max
ð5:3bÞ
© The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2024 E. Yuce, S. Minaei, Passive and Active Circuits by Example, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6_5
89
90
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Fig. 5.1 Representation of the practical OA
VCC V+
I+
+ OA
V-
-
I-
Iout
Vout
VEE Fig. 5.2 V+ - V- versus Vout characteristics
Vout
Vr+ A0
Vr-/A0
Vr+/A0
V+-V-
Vr-
where Iout,max is the maximum current that can be supplied by the OA. In Fig. 5.2, V+ - V- against Vout characteristics is given in which A0 is the slope. Example 5.1 If A = 104, Vr+ = 9 V, Vr- = -9 V, V+ = 5 V, and V- = -2 V are taken, find the value of Vout. Solution 5.1 From Eq. (5.1), Vout = A(V+ – V-), Vout = 104 × (5-(-2)) = 7 × 104 V is found. Vout cannot exceed 9 V; thus, Vout = 9 V. Example 5.2 If A = 104 Vr+ = 9 V, Vr- = -9 V, V+ = 0 V, and V- = 4 V are chosen, find the value of Vout. Solution 5.2 From Eq. (5.1), Vout = A(V+ - V-), Vout = 104 × (0 - 4) = -4 × 104 V is found. Vout cannot be less than -9 V; therefore, Vout = -9 V.
5.2
Ideal OAs
Two models for the OA can be given. These models are, respectively, given in Figs. 5.3 and 5.4. Vi and Vout in Fig. 5.3 are, respectively, calculated by Vi = Vþ - V -
ð5:4aÞ
5.2
Ideal OAs
91
Fig. 5.3 The first model for the OA
Rout
I+
V+
+ Vi
Rin V-
V+
+
-
-
AVi
Vout +
GmV-
Vout
I-
GmV+
V-
Iout
R
+ Vd
-
PVd
-
Fig. 5.4 The second model for the OA
V out = AV i þ I out Rout
ð5:4bÞ
V out = μV d = μGm RðV þ - V - Þ
ð5:5Þ
Vout in Fig. 5.4 is found as
Here, Vd = GmR(V+ - V-). An ideal OA-based model in Fig. 5.3 has the following properties: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15.
I+ = I- = 0. Rin = 1. A = 1. Rout = 0. Infinity bandwidth. No offset current. No offset voltage. Infinity slew rate (SR). Zero THD. Zero noise. Infinity dynamic range. Infinity common-mode rejection ratio. No parasitic resistors and capacitors. -1 ≤ Iout ≤ 1 -1 ≤ V+ ≤ 1, -1 ≤ V- ≤ 1, and -1 ≤ Vout ≤ 1
92
5
16. 17. 18. 19.
No restricted DC supply voltages. Infinity power supply rejection ratio. Infinity signal to noise ratio. No stability problem.
5.3
OA-Based Basic Circuits
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
In this section, OAs are considered as ideal (A → 1). Example 5.3 Find Vout/Vin of the inverting amplifier in Fig. 5.5. Solution 5.3 Due to infinite gain of the OA, V- = V+ = 0. Analysis of the circuit in Fig. 5.5 is performed as follows: R V in - V V - V out V = ) out = - 2 R1 R2 V in R1
ð5:6Þ
Thus, this amplifier has 180° phase difference between Vout and input voltage, Vin. Input resistance of the inverting amplifier Rin = R1 in which A → 1. Also, equivalent circuit of Fig. 5.5 is demonstrated in Fig. 5.6. Mechanical analogy of the inverting amplifier is depicted in Fig. 5.7 [5], while Vin - Vout characteristics of the inverting amplifier are depicted in Fig. 5.8. AC and transient responses of the inverting amplifier are, respectively, given in Figs. 5.9 and 5.10, where LM318/NS OA model is utilized. DC supply voltages of the OA are taken as ±12 V, while R1 = 1 kΩ and R2 = 5 kΩ are chosen. As it is seen from Fig. 5.9, -3 dB frequency (cutoff frequency) of the inverting amplifier is approximately 6.42 MHz. A
Vin
R1
R2
OA
Vout
+ Ao f Fig. 5.5 An inverting amplifier Fig. 5.6 Equivalent circuit of the inverting amplifier
Vin
Vout R1
+
-
-R2Vin /R1
5.3
OA-Based Basic Circuits
Fig. 5.7 Mechanical analogy of the inverting amplifier
93
Vin
R1
R2
Vout
Vout
–
R2 R1
Vin
Fig. 5.8 Vin - Vout characteristics of the inverting amplifier
Fig. 5.9 AC analysis result of the inverting amplifier
sinusoidal input voltage with peak 1 V at 100 kHz is applied. Thus, the results are shown in Fig. 5.10. Note As shown in Fig. 5.5, feedback is fed to – terminal of the OA. Otherwise, the inverting amplifier becomes unstable.
94
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Fig. 5.10 Transient analysis results of the inverting amplifier Fig. 5.11 A non-inverting amplifier
+
Vin
OA
-
Vout
Ao∞ R2
R1
Example 5.4 Find Vout/Vin of the non-inverting amplifier in Fig. 5.11. Solution 5.4 Analysis of the non-inverting amplifier given in Fig. 5.11 is achieved as in the following: R V out - V in V in V = ) out = 1 þ 2 R2 R1 V in R1
ð5:7Þ
Input resistance of the non-inverting amplifier Rin → 1. In addition, equivalent circuit of Fig. 5.11 is demonstrated in Fig. 5.12. Mechanical analogy of the non-inverting amplifier is depicted in Fig. 5.13 [5], while Vin - Vout characteristics of the non-inverting amplifier are plotted in Fig. 5.14.
5.3
OA-Based Basic Circuits
95
Fig. 5.12 Equivalent representation of the non-inverting amplifier
Vin
Vout +
-
Fig. 5.13 Mechanical analogy of the non-inverting amplifier
(1+R2 /R1)Vin
R2 Vout
R1
Vin
Vout
1+
R2 R1
Vin
Fig. 5.14 Vin - Vout characteristics of the non-inverting amplifier
R2=100 k:
Fig. 5.15 Topology of Example 5.5
Vin
R1=20 k: R3=20 k:
OA + A→f R4=20 k:
Vout R5=1 k:
Example 5.5 Find Vout/Vin and input resistance of the circuit depicted in Fig. 5.15. Solution 5.5 I+ = 0 A; thus, V+ = 0 V (R4 and R5 have no effect). V- = V+; accordingly, R3 has no effect. Therefore, Vout/Vin and Rin are, respectively, found as
96
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Fig. 5.16 Circuit of Example 5.6
R2 Iin
R3
OA
R1 +
Fig. 5.17 Simplified circuit of Example 5.6
R1+R2 R1Iin
_ +
Vout
A→f
R3
OA
Vout
+ A→f
R V out 100kΩ =- 2== -5 V in R1 20kΩ
ð5:8aÞ
Rin = R1 = 20kΩ
ð5:8bÞ
Example 5.6 Find Vout/Iin in the structure of Fig. 5.16. Solution 5.6 The circuit of Fig. 5.16 simplifies as given in Fig. 5.17 in which a source transformation technique is used. Hence, Vout/Iin is evaluated as R3 R1 R3 V out V = ) out = R1 I in R1 þ R2 I in R1 þ R2
ð5:9Þ
Example 5.7 If gain of the nominal value of the inverting amplifier is 10 and both resistors have 5% tolerance, find the range of Vout/Vin. Solution 5.7 The range of Vout/Vin is found below. - 10 ×
0:95 V out 1:05 V ≥ - 10 × ≥ ) - 9:05 ≥ out ≥ - 11:05 V in V in 1:05 0:95
ð5:10Þ
5.3
OA-Based Basic Circuits
97
Fig. 5.18 An integrator topology
C
Vin(s)
R
Vout(s)
OA + A→f Fig. 5.19 A differentiator circuit
R
C Vin(s)
OA
Vout(s)
+ A→f
Example 5.8 Analyze the integrator circuit depicted in Fig. 5.18. Solution 5.8 Transfer function (TF) of this structure in s domain is evaluated by V in ðsÞ 1 = - sCV out ðsÞ ) V out ðsÞ = V ðsÞ R sCR in V ðsÞ 1 =) H ðsÞ = out sCR V in ðsÞ
ð5:11Þ
Output voltage of the integrator in the time domain is calculated as t
1 vout ðt Þ = CR
vin ðτÞdτ
ð5:12Þ
-1
Example 5.9 Analyze the differentiator circuit demonstrated in Fig. 5.19. Solution 5.9 TF of this structure in s domain is calculated as follows: V in ðsÞsC = -
V out ðsÞ ) V out ðsÞ = - sCRV in ðsÞ R V ðsÞ ) H ðsÞ = out = - sCR V in ðsÞ
Output voltage of the differentiator in the time domain is found as
ð5:13Þ
98
5
Fig. 5.20 An antilogarithmic amplifier circuit based on a physical diode
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
R
Vin
D
OA
Vout
+ A→f Fig. 5.21 An antilogarithmic amplifier circuit based on a pnp-type BJT
R
BJT
Vin
OA
Vout
+ A→f Fig. 5.22 A logarithmic amplifier circuit based on a physical diode
D
Vin
R
OA
Vout
+ A→f
vout ðt Þ = - CR
dvin ðt Þ dt
ð5:14Þ
Example 5.10 Analyze the antilogarithmic amplifier topologies given in Figs. 5.20 and 5.21. A physical diode is used in Fig. 5.20, while a pnp-type BJT is utilized in Fig. 5.21. Solution 5.10 Analysis of these structures is performed as given below. I Se
V in - V VT
=
V in V - - V out ) V out = - RI S e V T R
ð5:15Þ
where IS is the saturation current and VT is the thermal voltage. Also, VT = kT/ q ffi 25 mV at room temperature that is 27 °C = 300 K. For Vin ≥ 5 VT, the circuits given in Figs. 5.20 and 5.21 operate properly. Example 5.11 Analyze the logarithmic amplifier circuits are depicted in Figs. 5.22 and 5.23. A physical diode is used in Fig. 5.22, while an npn type BJT is utilized in Fig. 5.23.
5.3
OA-Based Basic Circuits
99
Fig. 5.23 A logarithmic amplifier topology based on an npn type BJT
BJT
Vin
R
OA
Vout
+ A→f Fig. 5.24 A squarer based on a PMOS transistor, one resistor, and one OA
R
Vin
PMOS
OA
– VTP
Vout
+ A→f
NMOS
Fig. 5.25 A square rooter based on an NMOS transistor, one resistor, and one OA
Vin
R
-
VTN
OA
Vout
+ A→f
Solution 5.11 Analysis of these circuits is performed as given below. ISe
V - - V out VT
=
V in - V V ) V out = - V T ln in R I SR
ð5:16Þ
For Vout ≤ -5 VT, the circuits given in Figs. 5.22 and 5.23 operate properly. Example 5.12 Analyze the squarer circuit based on a PMOS transistor, one resistor, and one OA shown in Fig. 5.24. It is assumed that PMOS transistor works in the saturation region. Solution 5.12 Analysis of this structure is performed as given below. kp kp V - V out ðV - ð - jV TP jÞ - jV TP jÞ2 = ) V out = - R V 2in 2 in R 2
ð5:17Þ
Example 5.13 Analyze the square rooter circuit based on an NMOS transistor, one resistor, and one OA shown in Fig. 5.25. It is assumed that NMOS transistor works in the saturation region.
100
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Fig. 5.26 An analog adder structure
R1
V1 V2
V1
R1
OA
Vout
+ A→f
R2
OA (1) + A→f
V2
R2
R3
R3
Vo
R5
OA
Vout
(2) + A→f
R4
Fig. 5.27 A circuit for providing Vout = 3 V1 – 4 V2
Solution 5.13 Analysis of this topology is performed as V -VkN ðV TN - V out - V TN Þ2 = in ) V out = ± 2 R
2V in kN R
ð5:18Þ
where VGS > VTN must be satisfied; therefore, Vout is evaluated as in the following: V out = -
2V in kN R
ð5:19Þ
For the circuits in Figs. 5.24 and 5.25, Vin > 0 must be satisfied. Example 5.14 Analyze the analog adder circuit depicted in Fig. 5.26. Solution 5.14 Analysis of this circuit is performed by V V1 - V - V2 - V V - V out V þ = ) V out = - R3 1 þ 2 R1 R2 R3 R1 R2
ð5:20Þ
Example 5.15 Design a circuit for realizing Vout = 3 V1 – 4 V2. Solution 5.15 The structure for providing Vout = 3 V1 – 4 V2 is given in Fig. 5.27. Vout of the topology in Fig. 5.27 is found below.
5.3
V1
V2
V3 V4
OA-Based Basic Circuits
101
R3
R1
-
R4
OA
R2
(1) + A→f
Vo
R7
OA
Vout
(2) + A→f
R5 R6
Fig. 5.28 A circuit for providing Vout = 5 V1 + 4 V2 - 2.5 V3 – 2 V4
Vo = -
R2 R R R R R V ) V out = - 5 V o - 5 V 2 ) V out = 2 5 V 1 - 5 V 2 R1 1 R3 R4 R1 R3 R4
ð5:21Þ
It is observed from equation in (5.21) that if R1 = R4 = 1 kΩ, R2 = 3 kΩ, and R3 = R5 = 4 kΩ are chosen, Vout = 3 V1 – 4 V2 is easily obtained. Example 5.16 Design a circuit for realizing Vout = 5 V1 + 4 V2 – 2.5 V3 – 2 V4. Solution 5.16 The structure for providing Vout = 5 V1 + 4 V2 - 2.5 V3 – 2 V4 is given in Fig. 5.28. Vout of the circuit in Fig. 5.28 is evaluated as Vo = -
R3 R R R R V - 3 V ) V out = - 7 V o - 7 V 3 - 7 V 4 R1 1 R2 2 R4 R5 R6
ð5:22Þ
From Eq. (5.22), Vout of the circuit in Fig. 5.28 is recomputed as follows: V out =
R3 R7 R R R R V þ 3 7V - 7V - 7V R1 R4 1 R2 R4 2 R5 3 R6 4
ð5:23Þ
It is seen from equation given in (5.23) that if R1 = R3 = R4 = 1 kΩ, R2 = 1.25 kΩ, R5 = 2 kΩ, R6 = 2.5 kΩ, and R7 = 5 kΩ are taken, Vout = 5 V1 + 4 V2 - 2.5 V3 – 2 V4 is easily obtained. Example 5.17 Analyze the first-order low-pass filter (LPF) depicted in Fig. 5.29. Solution 5.17 Analysis of this topology is performed as follows: 1 V in = - V out sC þ R2 R1
) V out = -
R2 1 V R1 1 þ sCR2 in
ð5:24Þ
Example 5.18 Analyze the first-order high-pass filter (HPF) demonstrated in Fig. 5.30.
102
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Fig. 5.29 A first-order LPF
C
R2
R1
Vin
OA
Vout
+ A→f Fig. 5.30 A first-order HPF
R2 Vin(s)
C
R1
Vout(s)
OA
+ A→f
C1
C2
Vin(s)
R1
R2
OA
R4
R3
(1)
OA
+ A→f
(2)
Vout(s)
+ A→f Fig. 5.31 A topology for realizing TF given in (5.26)
Solution 5.18 Analysis of this topology is performed as - V out R R V in sCR1 s = ) V out = - 2 V =- 2 V 1 R2 R1 1 þ sCR1 in R1 s þ CR1 in R1 þ sC 1
ð5:25Þ
Example 5.19 Design a circuit for realizing the following TF: H ðsÞ =
100 1 þ 10s 7
2
ð5:26Þ
Solution 5.19 The circuit for providing TF in (5.26) is given in Fig. 5.31. This circuit can be easily obtained by cascading two first-order LPFs given in Fig. 5.29. Hence, TF of (5.26) becomes below.
5.3
OA-Based Basic Circuits
Vin(s)
R1
103
R2
C1
-
R3
OA (1)
C2
R4
OA (2)
+ A→f
Vout(s)
+ A→f
Fig. 5.32 A topology for providing TF given in (5.30)
H ðsÞ =
100 1 þ 10s 7
2
=
- 10 - 10 × 1 þ 10s 7 1 þ 10s 7
ð5:27Þ
From Eq. (5.27), H(s) simplifies as H ðsÞ =
- RR43 - RR21 - 10 - 10 × = × 1 þ 10s 7 1 þ 10s 7 1 þ sC1 R2 1 þ sC2 R4
ð5:28Þ
From Eq. (5.28), the following equations are obtained: R2 R4 = = 10 R1 R3
ð5:29aÞ
C1 R2 = C2 R4 = 10 - 7
ð5:29bÞ
If C1 = C2 = 100 pF are chosen, R2 = R4 = 1 kΩ and R1 = R3 = 100 Ω are found. Example 5.20 Design a topology for realizing the following TF: H ðsÞ =
100s2 s þ 107
2
ð5:30Þ
Solution 5.20 The circuit for providing TF of (5.30) is plotted in Fig. 5.32. This topology can be easily obtained by cascading two first-order HPFs given in Fig. 5.30. Therefore, TF of (5.30) becomes as H ðsÞ =
100s2 s þ 107
2
=
- RR43 s - RR21 s - 10s - 10s × = × s þ 107 s þ 107 s þ C11R1 s þ C21R3
From Eq. (5.31), the following equations are obtained:
ð5:31Þ
104
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
R2 R1
R6
-
Vin
OA (1)
C1
R4
Vo1
OA (2)
+ A→f
Vout
+ A→f C2 R3
OA (3)
Vo2
R5
+ A→f
Fig. 5.33 A topology for providing a PID controller
R2 R4 = = 10 R1 R3
ð5:32aÞ
C1 R1 = C2 R3 = 10 - 7
ð5:32bÞ
If C1 = C2 = 100 pF are taken, R1 = R3 = 1 kΩ and R2 = R4 = 10 kΩ are found. Example 5.21 Design a circuit for realizing the proportional integral derivative (PID) controller. Further, TF of the PID controller is defined as H ðsÞ = K p þ
1 þ sT d sT i
ð5:33Þ
Here, Kp, Ti, and Td are, respectively, called as proportional, integral, and derivative constants. Solution 5.21 The OA-based PID controller is demonstrated in Fig. 5.33. Analysis of this PID controller is achieved as follows: Firstly, Vo1 and Vo2 in Fig. 5.33 are, respectively, evaluated as sC 1 þ
1 V R V = - o1 ) V o1 = - 2 V in - sC 1 R2 V in R1 in R2 R1
ð5:34aÞ
V in V in = - sC 2 V o2 ) V o2 = R3 sC 2 R3
ð5:34bÞ
From equations in (5.34), Vout through Vo1 and Vo2 is computed as
5.3
OA-Based Basic Circuits
105
V out = -
R6 R V - 6V R4 o1 R5 o2
ð5:35Þ
By replacing Vo1 and Vo2 into Eq. (5.35), Vout is calculated below. V out =
R R6 R2 R6 1 þ þ sC 1 R2 6 V in R4 R1 R5 sC 2 R3 R4
= Kp þ
ð5:36Þ
1 þ sT d V in sT i
The parameters, Kp, Ti, and Td are, respectively, found as follows: R6 R2 R4 R1
ð5:37aÞ
C 2 R3 R5 R6
ð5:37bÞ
R6 R4
ð5:37cÞ
Kp = Ti =
T d = C 1 R2
Fig. 5.34 A voltage divider circuit
RS=100 k: +_
RS=100 k: + _
Vs=10V
Vs=10V
Iout
+ OA
-
Vout
A→f
Iout
Fig. 5.35 An example for the use of the voltage follower
RL=10 k:
Vout RL=10 k:
106
5.4
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Some More Examples Based on the OA
Example 5.22 Find Iout and Vout of the topologies depicted in Figs. 5.34 and 5.35. Solution 5.22 Iout and Vout of the circuit in Fig. 5.34 are, respectively, found as 10 ffi 0:0909mA 110k 10 V out = × 10 ffi 0:909V 110 I out =
ð5:38aÞ ð5:38bÞ
Iout and Vout of the circuit given in Fig. 5.35 are, respectively, evaluated below. I out =
10 = 1mA 10k
ð5:39aÞ
V out = 10V
ð5:39bÞ
Example 5.23 Design a circuit to obtain a current from the voltage. Solution 5.23 This circuit is shown in Fig. 5.36. Analysis of this circuit, the following current is obtained. I out =
V in R
ð5:40Þ
Example 5.24 Design a circuit to obtain a voltage from the current. Solution 5.24 This topology is depicted in Fig. 5.37. Analysis of this circuit, the following voltage is obtained: V out = - RI in
Fig. 5.36 The circuit of Example 5.23
ð5:41Þ
Vin
+ OA
-
A→f
Iout
R
5.4
Some More Examples Based on the OA
107
Fig. 5.37 The circuit of Example 5.24
R
-
Iin
OA
Vout
+ A→f Fig. 5.38 The circuit of Example 5.25
R2
Iin
OA
R1 +
Fig. 5.39 The obtained circuit by performing source transformation to Example 5.25
Vout
A→f
RL
R2 R1 R1Iin
OA
+ _
+ A→f
Vout
RL
Example 5.25 Find output voltage of the circuit in Fig. 5.38 in terms of the applied input current. Solution 5.25 No current is passing through resistor R1 resulting in IR2 = Iin. Therefore, output voltage is computed as V out = - R2 I in
ð5:42Þ
The second approach for solution of Example 5.25 is source transformation technique. Therefore, the structure in Fig. 5.38 is obtained as in Fig. 5.39, and the following output voltage is found: V I in R1 = - out ) V out = - R2 I in R1 R2
ð5:43Þ
Example 5.26 Find output voltage of the circuit in Fig. 5.40 in terms of the applied input current.
108
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
-
Fig. 5.40 The circuit of Example 5.26
OA
Iin R1
+
Vout
A→f
Vtest R3 I //
R2 I /
Solution 5.26 Vtest is firstly calculated as I in =
0 - V test ) V test = - R1 I in R1
ð5:44Þ
The currents I/ and I// are, respectively, computed as follows: I= =
0 - V test R = 1 I in R2 R2
I == = I = þ I in = 1 þ
ð5:45aÞ
R1 I R2 in
ð5:45bÞ
From equations in (5.45), Vout is evaluated as V out = V test - I == R3 = - R1 I in - 1 þ R R = - R1 þ R3 þ 1 3 I in R2
5.5
R1 I R R2 in 3
ð5:46Þ
Finite Open Loop Gain of the OA
In practice, open loop gain A < 1. In other words, A takes values between 104 ≤ A ≤ 106 where value of A is taken as DC. Actually, A is frequency dependent and decreases as the frequency rises. In this subsection, effect of the finite open loop gain of the OA on the output of the inverting amplifier, non-inverting amplifier, and voltage follower (VF) is investigated.
5.5
Finite Open Loop Gain of the OA
Fig. 5.41 An inverting amplifier with a finite gain OA
109
R2
R1
Vin
V-
OA +
Fig. 5.42 A non-inverting amplifier with a finite gain OA
Vout
A 4.8 V (Vout = -9 V), the OA saturates. Example 5.52 Find the range of R2 for the circuit in Fig. 5.52 such that OA operates in linear region in which Vr = ±9 V. Solution 5.52 V+ = V- is calculated by Vþ = V - = - 5 ×
10 = - 2V 25
ð5:104Þ
The range of Vout is computed as - 9 V ≤ V out ≤ 9 V
ð5:105Þ
From KVL, the following equation is obtained: V - V out -5 þ 2 - 2 - V out -5-V= ) = R1 R2 R2 2k
ð5:106Þ
From Eq. (5.106), Vout is calculated as V out = - 2 þ
3 R 2k 2
ð5:107Þ
From Eq. (5.107), the range of R2 is evaluated as follows: -9≤ -2 þ
22 3 kΩ R ≤ 9 ) R2 ≤ 3 2k 2
ð5:108Þ
5.10
Simulated Grounded Inductors
5.10
123
Simulated Grounded Inductors
Simulated inductors (SIs), namely, synthetic inductors, can be mainly categorized into two subgroups, grounded and floating ones. In addition, SIs can be divided into two subsections, lossy and lossless ones. In this subsection, simulated grounded inductors (SGIs) are investigated. SGIs behave like an inductor in a certain frequency range.
5.10.1
Lossy SGIs
Example 5.53 Find the input impedance of the parallel lossy SGI depicted in Fig. 5.53 [6]. Solution 5.53 Analysis of this circuit is accomplished below. I in =
V in - V test V in þ R1 R2
ð5:109aÞ
V V in = - sCV test ) V test = - in R2 sCR2
ð5:109bÞ
If Vtest in Eq. (5.109b) is replaced into Eq. (5.109a), Iin in terms of Vin is computed as I in =
V in V in V in þ þ R2 R1 sCR1 R2
ð5:110Þ
From equation in (5.110), Zin = Vin/Iin is evaluated by
Fig. 5.53 A parallel lossy SGI
R1
C Vtest
Vin
Iin
R2
OA + A→f
Zin
124
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Fig. 5.54 An equivalent circuit for the parallel lossy SGI in Fig. 5.53
Vin
Iin Req
Leq
Zin R1
C Vtest
Vin
Iin
+ OA (1)
-
R2
A→f
OA (2) + A→f
Zin Fig. 5.55 Another parallel lossy SGI
Z in =
V in = I in
1 R1
1 = sLeq ==Req þ R12 þ sCR11 R2
ð5:111Þ
Here, Leq = CR1R2 and Req = R1//R2. Equivalent circuit for the parallel lossy SGI is given in Fig. 5.54. Example 5.54 Find the input impedance of another parallel lossy SGI shown in Fig. 5.55 [7]. Solution 5.54 Analysis of this circuit is achieved below. I in =
V in - V test R1
V V in = - V test sC ) V test = - in R2 sCR2
ð5:112aÞ ð5:112bÞ
If Vtest in Eq. (5.112b) is replaced into Eq. (5.112a), Iin in terms of Vin is calculated by I in =
V in V in þ R1 sCR1 R2
From above equation, Zin = Vin/Iin is found as
ð5:113Þ
5.10
Simulated Grounded Inductors
125
Fig. 5.56 A series lossy SGI
OA Vin
+ A→f
Iin
C
R1
Vtest
Zin
R2
Z in =
V in = I in
1 1 R1
þ sCR11 R2
= sLeq ==Req
ð5:114Þ
where Leq = CR1R2 and Req = R1. Example 5.55 Find the input impedance of the series lossy SGI demonstrated in Fig. 5.56 [8]. Solution 5.55 Analysis of this structure is accomplished as follows: I in =
V in - V test R1
ð5:115aÞ
V in - V test V þ ðV in - V test ÞsC = test R1 R2
ð5:115bÞ
Expansion of equation in (5.115b), the following equation is obtained: V in V V þ sCV in = test þ test þ sCV test R1 R1 R2
ð5:116Þ
From equation given in (5.116), Vtest is evaluated as V test =
1 R1 1 R1
þ sC
þ R12 þ sC
V in
If Vtest in Eq. (5.117) is replaced in Eq. (5.115a), Iin is found below.
ð5:117Þ
126
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Fig. 5.57 An equivalent circuit for the series lossy SGI
Vin
Iin Req Leq
I in =
V in -
1 R1 þsC 1 1 þ R1 R2 þsC
V in
=
R1
1 1 R1 þR2 þsC 1 1 þ R1 R2 þsC
V in þ
- R1 - sC 1 1 1 R1 þR2 þsC
V in
R1
ð5:118Þ
Simplification of equation in (5.118), the following equation is found:
I in =
1 R2 1 1 R1 þR2 þsC
V in
ð5:119Þ
R1
Further simplification of equation in (5.119), the following equation is obtained: 1 R2
I in =
× R2
1 1 R1 þR2 þsC
× R2
R1 ×
V in ×
1 R1
ð5:120Þ
1 R1
From equation in (5.120), Zin is evaluated as follows: Z in =
V in = R1 þ R2 þ sCR1 R2 = Req þ sLeq I in
ð5:121Þ
Here, Leq = CR1R2 and Req = R1 + R2. Further, an equivalent circuit for the series lossy SGI is depicted in Fig. 5.57. Example 5.56 Find the input impedance of another series lossy SGI shown in Fig. 5.58 [7]. Solution 5.56 Analysis of this topology is carried out as in the following two equations: I in =
V in - V test R1
ðV in - V test ÞsC =
V test R2
Expansion of equation in (5.122b), the following equation is obtained:
ð5:122aÞ ð5:122bÞ
5.10
Simulated Grounded Inductors
127
OA (2) Vin
+ A→f
Iin
C
R1 Vtest
+
Zin
OA (1)
R2
-
A→f
Fig. 5.58 Another series lossy SGI
sCV in =
V test þ sCV test R2
ð5:123Þ
From above equation, Vtest is calculated as V test =
1 R2
sC V in þ sC
ð5:124Þ
If Vtest in Eq. (5.124) is replaced into Eq. (5.122a), the following equation is found:
I in =
V in -
sC
1 R2 þsC
V in
R1
=
1 R2 þsC 1 R2 þsC
V in þ R1
- sC
1 R2 þsC
V in
ð5:125Þ
From equation given in (5.125), Iin is computed as
I in =
1 R2 1 R2 þsC
V in
ð5:126Þ
R1
Simplifying equation in (5.126), Iin is obtained below. 1 R2
I in =
× R2
1 R2 þsC
× R2
R1 ×
From equation in (5.127), Zin is evaluated as
V in × 1 R1
1 R1
ð5:127Þ
128
5
Z in =
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
V in = R1 þ sCR1 R2 = Req þ sLeq I in
ð5:128Þ
where Leq = CR1R2 and Req = R1.
5.10.2
Lossless SGIs
In this subsection, negative/positive lossless SGIs by example are treated. Example 5.57 Find the input impedance of the negative lossless SGI depicted in Fig. 5.59. Solution 5.57 Analysis of this structure is achieved by the following two equations: I in =
V in - V test R1
ðV test - V in ÞsC =
ð5:129aÞ V in R2
ð5:129bÞ
Expansion of equation in (5.129b), the following equation is found: V in - V test = -
V in sCR2
ð5:130Þ
If equation in (5.130) is replaced into equation in (5.129a), the following input impedance is evaluated:
Fig. 5.59 A negative lossless SGI
R1
Vin
+
Iin
OA
-
A→f
Zin C R2
Vtest
5.10
Simulated Grounded Inductors
129
(1)
Vin
Iin
R1
R2
R4
OA +
-
A→f
V2
C
V1 + OA (2)
Zin
R3
A→f
Fig. 5.60 A positive lossless SGI
Z in =
V in = - sCR1 R2 = - sLeq I in
ð5:131Þ
Here, Leq = CR1R2. Example 5.58 Find the input impedance of the positive lossless SGI given in Fig. 5.60 [9]. Solution 5.58 Analysis of this circuit is achieved by the following three equations: I in =
V in - V 1 R1
ð5:132aÞ
V 1 - V in V in - V 2 = R4 R2
ð5:132bÞ
V in R3
ð5:132cÞ
ðV 2 - V in ÞsC = From equations in (5.132), Zin is calculated by Z in =
V in sCR1 R2 R3 = = sLeq I in R4
ð5:133Þ
Here, Leq = CR1R2R3/R4. Example 5.59 Find the input impedance of another positive lossless SGI demonstrated in Fig. 5.61 [10].
130
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
R1 V2 C1
R2 Vin
Iin
+
V1 OA (1)
-
-
V1
A→f
C2
Zin
OA (2) + A→f
R3
Fig. 5.61 Another positive lossless SGI
Solution 5.59 This structure is analyzed by the following three equations: I in =
V in - V 2 R1
ð5:134aÞ
V in - V 1 = ðV 1 - V 2 ÞsC 1 R2 ðV in - V 1 ÞsC 2 =
V1 R3
ð5:134bÞ ð5:134cÞ
From equations given in (5.134), Zin is computed as follows: Z in =
V in sC 1 R1 R2 ð1 þ sC2 R3 Þ = 1 þ sC 1 R2 I in
ð5:135Þ
If the following matching condition is met: C 2 R3 = C 1 R2
ð5:136Þ
Input impedance of this SGI becomes as Z in =
V in = sC 1 R1 R2 = sLeq I in
ð5:137Þ
In above equation, Leq = C1R1R2. Example 5.60 Find the input impedance of the single OA-based positive lossless SGI shown in Fig. 5.62 [11].
5.10
Simulated Grounded Inductors
131
Fig. 5.62 A single OA-based positive lossless SGI.
R6
V2 C
R3
Vin
Iin
V1 R1
R4
-
V1
Zin
V3
R5
OA + A→f
R2
Solution 5.60 This circuit is analyzed by the following four equations: I in =
V in - V 1 V in - V 1 V in - V 3 þ þ R3 R1 R6 V in - V 1 = ðV 1 - V 2 ÞsC R3
ðV 1 - V 2 ÞsC =
V2 - V3 V2 þ R5 R4
V in - V 1 V 1 = R1 R2
ð5:138aÞ ð5:138bÞ ð5:138cÞ ð5:138dÞ
From equations indicated in (5.138), Zin is found below. Z in = =
V in I in
sC ðR1 þ R2 ÞR3 R4 R6 R1 ðR4 þ R5 Þ þ sC ðR1 R3 R4 þ R1 R4 R5 þ R1 R4 R6 þ R3 R4 R6 - R2 R3 R5 Þ ð5:139Þ
In above equation, if the following matching constraint is met, R1 R3 R4 þ R1 R4 R5 þ R1 R4 R6 þ R3 R4 R6 = R2 R3 R5 Zin simplifies as
ð5:140Þ
132
5
Z in =
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
V in sC ðR1 þ R2 ÞR3 R4 R6 = = sLeq I in R1 ðR4 þ R5 Þ
ð5:141Þ
Note Mathematical programs should be used in calculation of the input impedances of the SGIs in Figs. 5.60, 5.61, and 5.62.
5.11
Rectifiers
Rectifiers can be divided into two subgroups, half-wave rectifiers (HWRs) and fullwave rectifiers (FWRs). Example 5.61 Find the output voltage of the simple single OA-based HWR given in Fig. 5.63 [4]. Solution 5.61 This HWR is analyzed as follows: If vin ðt Þ ≥ 0 is taken, diode is ON ) vout ðt Þ = vin ðt Þ
ð5:142aÞ
If vin ðt Þ < 0 is taken, diode is OFF ) vout ðt Þ = 0
ð5:142bÞ
A drawback of this circuit is that the OA is in saturation when vin(t) < 0 and OA can be destroyed if the magnitude of the input voltage is larger than a few volts. Vin-Vout characteristics of the HWR of Fig. 5.63 are depicted in Fig. 5.64. Example 5.62 Find the output voltage of another single OA-based HWR shown in Fig. 5.65. Fig. 5.63 A single OA-based HWR
vin(t)
+
D
vout(t)
OA
-
A→f
RL
Fig. 5.64 Vin-Vout characteristics of the HWR in Fig. 5.63
Vout 1
Vin
5.11
Rectifiers
Fig. 5.65 Another single OA-based HWR
133
vin(t)
R2
R1
vout(t) D2
D1
OA
+ A→f Fig. 5.66 Vin-Vout characteristics of the HWR in Fig. 5.65
Vout –
R2 R1
Vin
Solution 5.62 This HWR is analyzed below. If vin ðt Þ ≥ 0 is taken, D1 is ON and D2 is OFF ) vout ðt Þ = 0 If vin ðt Þ < 0 is taken, D1 is OFF and D2 is ON ) vout ðt Þ = -
ð5:143aÞ
R2 v ðt Þ ð5:143bÞ R1 in
Vin-Vout characteristics of the HWR in Fig. 5.65 are demonstrated in Fig. 5.66. Example 5.63 Find the output voltage of the OA-based FWR shown in Fig. 5.67 [4]. Solution 5.63 This circuit for R2 = R1 is analyzed as in the following: If vin ðt Þ ≥ 0 is chosen D1 is ON and D2 is OFF ) vout ðt Þ = vin ðt Þ
ð5:144aÞ
If vin ðt Þ < 0 is chosen D1 is OFF and D2 is ON ) vout ðt Þ = - vin ðt Þ
ð5:144bÞ
From equations denoted in (5.144), vout(t) is evaluated as vout ðt Þ = jvin ðt Þj
ð5:145Þ
Vin-Vout characteristics of the FWR in Fig. 5.67 are shown in Fig. 5.68. Example 5.64 Find the output voltage of another OA-based FWR depicted in Fig. 5.69 [12].
134
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
OA vin(t)
(1)
D1
+ A→f
vout(t)
R2
R1
OA
(2)
D2
+ A→f Fig. 5.67 An OA-based FWR Fig. 5.68 Vin-Vout characteristics of the FWR in Fig. 5.67
Vout 1
-1
Vin
R
vin(t)
R
R
D2
D1
OA
(1)
+ A→f Fig. 5.69 Another OA-based FWR
aR
R/2
Vo
OA
(2)
+ A→f
vout(t)
5.12
Wien Oscillators
135
Fig. 5.70 Vin-Vout characteristics of the FWR in Fig. 5.69
Vout a
-a
Vin Fig. 5.71 A Wien oscillator
R4
OA
R1
Vout
+ A→f
C1 R3 R2
C2
Solution 5.64 This structure with four resistive matching condition is analyzed as If vin ðtÞ ≥ 0 is taken, D1 is OFF and D2 is ON ) vout ðtÞ = - ðaR=RÞðvin ðtÞÞ - aRðR=2Þð - vin ðtÞÞ = avin ðtÞ If vin ðtÞ < 0 is taken, D1 is ON and D2 is OFF ) vout ðt Þ = - ðaR=RÞðvin ðt ÞÞ - 0 = - avin ðt Þ
ð5:146aÞ ð5:146bÞ
Therefore, vout(t) is calculated as vout ðt Þ = ajvin ðt Þj
ð5:147Þ
Vin-Vout characteristics of the FWR in Fig. 5.69 are depicted in Fig. 5.70.
5.12
Wien Oscillators
Wien oscillators provide only one sinusoidal output. Example 5.65 Find the characteristic eq. (D(s)), oscillation condition (OC), and oscillation frequency (OF) of the Wien oscillator demonstrated in Fig. 5.71 [13].
136
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Solution 5.65 Its analysis is carried out by the following three equations: V - = Vþ
ð5:148aÞ
VV out - V = R4 R1 þ sC1 1
ð5:148bÞ
1 V out - V þ = V þ sC 2 þ R2 R3
ð5:148cÞ
By using equations in (5.148a) and (5.148b), Vout in terms of V+ is found as V out =
R4 þ R1 þ sC1 1 R4 V þ V = Vþ þ þ R1 þ sC1 1 R1 þ sC1 1
ð5:149Þ
If both numerator and denominator are multiplied by sC1, Vout becomes as V out =
R1 þ R4 sC 1 þ 1 Vþ sC 1 R1 þ 1
ð5:150Þ
If equation in (5.148c) is rearranged, Vout by means of V+ is found as follows: V out = V þ sC 2 R3 þ
R3 þ1 R2
ð5:151Þ
Equation given in (5.150) equal to equation in (5.151); thus, the following equation is obtained: V out = V þ sC 2 R3 þ
R þ R4 sC 1 þ 1 R3 þ 1 = Vþ 1 R2 sC 1 R1 þ 1
ð5:152Þ
From equation in (5.152), the following equation is obtained: R
sC 2 R3 þ R32 þ 1 R þ R4 sC 1 þ 1 = 1 1 sC1 R1 þ 1
ð5:153Þ
Similarly, from equation in (5.153), the following equation is obtained: sC 2 R3 þ
R3 þ1 R2
sC1 R1 þ 1 = R1 þ R4 sC 1 þ 1
Expansion of equation in (5.154), the following equation is found:
ð5:154Þ
5.12
Wien Oscillators
137
Fig. 5.72 Another Wien oscillator
R1
OA
R2
+ A→f R3 R4
s2 C 1 C 2 R 1 R 3 þ s C 1 R 1
Vout
C1
C2
R3 þ C2 R3 - C1 R4 R2
þ
R3 =0 R2
ð5:155Þ
If both sides of equation in (5.155) are multiplied by R2/R3, the following D(s) is obtained: DðsÞ = s2 C1 C2 R1 R2 þ s C 1 R1 þ C 2 R2 - C 1
R2 R4 R3
þ 1=0
ð5:156Þ
From equation given in (5.156), the following OC and OF are, respectively, obtained as C1
R2 R4 ≥ C1 R1 þ C 2 R2 R3
f0 =
1 2π
1 C 1 C 2 R1 R2
ð5:157aÞ ð5:157bÞ
Example 5.66 Find D(s), OC, and OF of another Wien oscillator shown in Fig. 5.72 [4]. Solution 5.66 Analysis of this topology is achieved by the following two equations: V - = Vþ = V out -
R2 R1 þR2 V out R3 þ sC1 1
=
R2 V R1 þ R2 out
R2 1 V sC 2 þ R4 R1 þ R2 out
From equation in (5.158b), D(s) is evaluated as
ð5:158aÞ ð5:158bÞ
138
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
C 1 R1 R4 R2
DðsÞ = s2 C1 C2 R3 R4 þ s C 1 R3 þ C 2 R4 -
þ 1=0
ð5:159Þ
From equations given in (5.159), OC and OF are, respectively, computed below. C 1 R1 R4 ≥ C 1 R3 þ C2 R4 R2 f0 =
5.13
1 2π
ð5:160aÞ
1 C 1 C 2 R3 R4
ð5:160bÞ
Analog Filters
Analog filters can be mainly divided into three subcategories, first-order filters, second-order filters, and high-order filters. In this subsection, it is dealt with firstorder and second-order ones. Example 5.67 Find the first-order all-pass filter (APF) depicted in Fig. 5.73 [14]. Solution 5.67 This filter is analyzed as follows: V - = Vþ = V in -
1 1þsCR V in
R1
1 V 1 þ sCR in
=
1 1þsCR V in
ð5:161aÞ
- V out
ð5:161bÞ
R2
From above equations, TF is computed by
Fig. 5.73 A first-order APF
R2 R1
OA
Vin R
+ C
A→f
Vout
5.13
Analog Filters
139 C1
Vin
R1 Vtest
+
-
R2
(1)
OA
+ OA
A→f
C2
-
(2)
Vout
A→f
Fig. 5.74 A second-order LPF
1 - sCR RR21 V out H ðsÞ = = V in 1 þ sCR
ð5:162Þ
If R2 = R1 is taken for equation in (5.162), TF of this filter becomes below. H ðsÞ =
1 - sCR V out = 1 þ sCR V in
ð5:163Þ
Example 5.68 Find the TF of the second-order LPF exhibited in Fig. 5.74 [15]. Solution 5.68 Analysis of this circuit is achieved by the following two equations: V in - V test = ðV test - V out ÞsC1 R1 V test - V out = V out sC 2 ) V test = V out ð1 þ sC 2 R2 Þ R2
ð5:164aÞ ð5:164bÞ
From above equations, TF is evaluated as 1
H ðsÞ =
ω20 V out C 1 C 2 R1 R2 = 2 = 2 1 1 V in s þ s C1 R1 þ C1 C2 R1 R2 s þ s ωQ0 þ ω20
ð5:165Þ
where angular resonance frequency (ω0) and quality factor (Q) are, respectively, found as ω20 =
1 ) ω0 = C 1 C 2 R1 R2 ω0 1 = ) Q= Q C 1 R1
1 C 1 C 2 R1 R2 C1 R1 C2 R2
ð5:166aÞ ð5:166bÞ
Example 5.69 Find the TF of the multiple feedback second-order LPF demonstrated in Fig. 5.75.
140
5
R2
C1 R3
R1
Vin
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Vtest
OA
C2
Vout
+ A→f
Fig. 5.75 A multiple feedback second-order LPF
Solution 5.69 Analysis of this circuit is achieved by the following two equations: V in - V test V - V out V test = test þ þ V test sC 2 R1 R2 R3
ð5:167aÞ
V test = - V out sC 1 ) V test = - V out sC 1 R3 R3
ð5:167bÞ
From equations in (5.167), the following TF is computed: H ðsÞ =
1 V out R =- 2 V in R1 s2 C C R R þ sC R þ R þ R2 R3 þ 1 1 2 2 3 1 2 3 R1
ð5:168Þ
Here, ω0 and Q are, respectively, evaluated as ω20 =
1 ) ω0 = C 1 C 2 R2 R3
1 C 1 C 2 R2 R3
R2 R3 ω0 R2 þ R3 þ R1 1 ) Q= = Q C 2 R2 R3 R2 þ R3 þ RR2 R1 3
C 2 R2 R3 C1
ð5:169aÞ ð5:169bÞ
Example 5.70 Find the TF of the second-order LPF demonstrated in Fig. 5.76 [16]. Solution 5.70 This LPF is analyzed by the following two equations: V - V out V in - V test = ðV test - V out ÞsC 1 þ test R1 R2 V test - V out = V out sC 2 ) V test = V out ð1 þ sC2 R2 Þ R2 From above equations, the following TF is obtained:
ð5:170aÞ ð5:170bÞ
5.13
Analog Filters
141
C1
Vin
R1
R2
+
Vtest
OA C2
-
Vout
A→f
Fig. 5.76 A second-order LPF
R2
Vin
C1
R1
+
Vtest
OA R3
C2
-
Vout
A→f
Fig. 5.77 A Sallen-Key second-order BPF
H ðsÞ =
V out 1 = 2 V in s C 1 C 2 R1 R2 þ sC 2 ðR1 þ R2 Þ þ 1
ð5:171Þ
where ω0 and Q are, respectively, found as follows: ω20 =
1 ) ω0 = C 1 C 2 R1 R2
1 C 1 C 2 R1 R2
ω0 R1 þ R2 1 ) Q= = Q C 1 R1 R2 R1 þ R2
C 1 R1 R2 C2
ð5:172aÞ ð5:172bÞ
Note If RC-CR transformations are performed for the LPFs in Figs. 5.74, 5.75, and 5.76, HPFs are obtained. Example 5.71 Find the TF of the Sallen-Key second-order band-pass filter (BPF) shown in Fig. 5.77.
142
5
C1
R2 C2
R1
Vin
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Vtest
OA
R3
Vout
+ A→f
Fig. 5.78 A multiple feedback second-order BPF
Solution 5.71 Analysis of this topology is carried by the following two equations: V in - V test V - V out = test þ ðV test - V out ÞsC 1 þ V test sC 2 R1 R2 ðV test - V out ÞsC1 =
V out 1 ) V test = V out 1 þ sC1 R3 R3
ð5:173aÞ ð5:173bÞ
From above equations, the following TF is calculated: H ðsÞ =
sC 1 R2 R3 V out = 2 V in s C1 C2 R1 R2 R3 þ sðC 1 R1 R2 þ C2 R1 R2 þ C 1 R2 R3 Þ þ R1 þ R2 ð5:174Þ
From equation in (5.174), ω0 and Q are, respectively, computed as ω20 =
R1 þ R2 ) ω0 = C 1 C 2 R1 R2 R3
R1 þ R2 C 1 C 2 R1 R2 R3
ðR1 þ R2 ÞC1 C 2 R1 R2 R3 ω0 C1 R1 R2 þ C 2 R1 R2 þ C1 R2 R3 = ) Q= C1 R1 R2 þ C 2 R1 R2 þ C1 R2 R3 Q C1 C2 R1 R2 R3
ð5:175aÞ ð5:175bÞ
Example 5.72 Find the TF of the multiple feedback second-order BPF depicted in Fig. 5.78. Solution 5.72 Analysis of this circuit is accomplished by the following two equations: V V in - V test = ðV test - V out ÞsC 1 þ V test sC 2 þ test R1 R3
ð5:176aÞ
5.13
Analog Filters
143
C1 Vin
R2 C2
R1
-
Vtest
OA
Vout
+ A→f Fig. 5.79 Deliyannis second-order BPF
V test sC 2 = -
V out V ) V test = - out R2 sC 2 R2
ð5:176bÞ
From above equations, the following TF is found: H ðsÞ =
sC2 R2 R3 V out =- 2 V in s C 1 C 2 R1 R2 R3 þ sðC1 þ C2 ÞR1 R3 þ R1 þ R3
ð5:177Þ
Here, ω0 and Q are, respectively, found below. ω20 =
R1 þ R3 ) ω0 = C 1 C 2 R1 R2 R3
1 ω0 C 1 þ C 2 ) Q= = Q C1 C2 R2 C1 þ C2
R1 þ R3 C 1 C 2 R1 R2 R3
ð5:178aÞ
ðR1 þ R3 ÞC 1 C 2 R2 R1 R3
ð5:178bÞ
Example 5.73 Find the TF of the Deliyannis second-order BPF demonstrated in Fig. 5.79. Solution 5.73 Analysis of this structure is achieved by the following two equations: V in - V test = ðV test - V out ÞsC1 þ V test sC 2 R1 V test sC 2 = -
V out V ) V test = - out R2 sC 2 R2
ð5:179aÞ ð5:179bÞ
From above equations, the following TF is evaluated: H ðsÞ =
V out sC 2 R2 =- 2 V in s C 1 C 2 R1 R2 þ sðC 1 þ C 2 ÞR1 þ 1
where ω0 and Q are, respectively, found by
ð5:180Þ
144
5
ω20 =
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
1 ) ω0 = C 1 C 2 R1 R2
1 C 1 C 2 R1 R2
ω0 C 1 þ C 2 1 ) Q= = Q C 1 C 2 R2 C1 þ C2
5.14
ð5:181aÞ
C 1 C 2 R2 R1
ð5:181bÞ
Large Signal Operation in the OA
If LM318/NS type OA is supplied with ±12 V, output voltage (Vout) of this OA is generally less than 9 V and greater than -9 V. In other words, Vout is restricted with ±9 V. These restricted voltages are called as rated voltages that are defined below. V rþ ffi 9 V < V CC
ð5:182aÞ
V r - ffi - 9 V > V EE
ð5:182bÞ
Output current (Iout) of any OA cannot exceed Iout,max. For example, LM318/NS type OA has Iout,max ffi 21 mA. Iout, for LM318/NS OA is found as jI out j ≤ I out, max ffi 21 mA
ð5:183Þ
Example 5.74 Find vout(t) and iout(t) in Fig. 5.80 if Vr ffi ±9 V and vin(t) = (1 V)sin (ωt) are taken.
Fig. 5.80 A non-inverting amplifier with a load
VCC vin(t)
+ OA
iout(t)
vout(t)
VEE R2=10 k: R1=2 k:
RL=0.5 k:
5.15
SR
145
Solution 5.74 vout(t) and iout(t) are, respectively, computed as vout ðt Þ = 1 þ iout ðtÞ =
10 sinðωt Þ = 6 sinðωt Þ 2
6 6 sin ðωtÞ = 12:5ðmAÞsinðωtÞ þ 12k 0:5k
ð5:184aÞ ð5:184bÞ
Example 5.75 Find vout(t) in Fig. 5.80 if Vr ffi ±9 V and vin(t) = (2 V)sin(ωt) are chosen. Solution 5.75 vout(t) is calculated by vout ðtÞ = 1 þ
10 × 2sin ðωtÞ = 12sin ðωtÞ 2
ð5:185Þ
However, in Eq. (5.185), vout(t) is limited at about ±9 V as shown in Fig. 5.81. iout(t) of Example 5.75 is drawn in Fig. 5.81. In addition, f = 10 kHz is taken, where LM318/NS OA model is used.
5.15
SR
SR is a nonlinear distortion [4]. SR occurs at high frequencies and is defined as follows: SR =
dvout ðtÞ dt
max
ð5:186Þ
Unit of the SR is V/μs. In order to express SR, an input voltage depicted in Fig. 5.82 (a pulse) is applied to the VF in Fig. 5.83, where VI is sufficiently high. SR is found from slope of vout(t) in Fig. 5.82. Example 5.76 Find vout(t), if vin(t) = VIu(t) is applied to the input of the VF shown in Fig. 5.83 and VI is sufficiently small (ωtVI ≤ SR). Solution 5.76 vout(t) is evaluated as follows [3, 4]: From equation given in (5.59), output voltage, vout(t) of the VF of Fig. 5.83 in s domain is found as V out ðsÞ =
A0 1 1 V in ðsÞ ffi s s V in ðsÞ 1 þ 1 þ A0 1 þ ωb ð1þA ωt Þ 0
Input voltage, vin(t) in s domain is calculated by
ð5:187Þ
146
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Fig. 5.81 vin(t), vout(t), and iout(t) of Example 5.75
V in ðsÞ =
VI s
ð5:188Þ
From equations denoted in (5.187) and (5.188), vout(t) of the VF of Fig. 5.83 in s domain is found as follows:
5.15
SR
147
vin(t)
Fig. 5.82 Input and output voltages of the VF
vout(t)
VI -SR
SR
t
Fig. 5.83 A VF given to test SR
vin (t)
+ OA
vout (t)
-
V out ðsÞ =
1 V V VI × I = I 1 þ ωst s s s þ ωt
ð5:189Þ
From above equation, vout(t) of the VF of Fig. 5.83 is computed as vout ðt Þ = V I ð1 - e - tωt Þ
ð5:190Þ
Here, ωt = 2πft is calculated in Eq. (5.78). tr, namely, rise time, is defined as the time of vout(t) to reach from 10% to 90%. Furthermore, tr is computed by tr =
1 lnð9Þ ωt
ð5:191Þ
Above equation is obtained as follows: 0:1 × V I = V I ð1 - e - t1 ωt Þ ) t 1 =
1 1 ln ωt 0:9
ð5:192aÞ
1 lnð10Þ ωt
ð5:192bÞ
0:9 × V I = V I ð1 - e - t2 ωt Þ ) t 2 = tr = t2 - t1 =
1 1 lnð10 × 0:9Þ = lnð9Þ ωt ωt
ð5:192cÞ
Otherwise, for ωtVI > SR, tr is calculated as below. tr =
V VI × ð0:9 - 0:1Þ = I × 0:8 SR SR
ð5:193Þ
In Fig. 5.84, input and output voltages of the VF at various frequencies are given in which input voltage is taken as 5 V peak, and the LM318/NS OA model is utilized.
148
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Fig. 5.84 Input and output voltages of the VF at various frequencies
Example 5.77 Find tr if the VF has SR = 107 V/s, ft = 10 MHz, and Vin(t) = 100 (mV)u(t). Solution 5.77 Firstly, the following condition is checked. ωt V I = 2π × 107 × 0:1 ffi 6:28 × 106 ≤ SR = 107
ð5:194Þ
From equation in (5.192c), tr is found by tr =
1 1 lnð9Þ = lnð9Þ ffi 35 ns ωt 2π × 107
ð5:195Þ
Example 5.78 Find tr if the VF has SR = 107 V/s, ft = 10 MHz, and VI = Vin(t) = 1 (V)u(t). Solution 5.78 Firstly, the following condition is checked. ωt V I = 2π × 107 × 1 ffi 6:28 × 107 > SR = 107
ð5:196Þ
From equation given in (5.193), tr is found as given below. tr =
1 VI × 0:8 = 7 × 0:8 = 80 ns SR 10
ð5:197Þ
5.16
5.16
Full-Power Bandwidth
149
Full-Power Bandwidth
Full-power bandwidth ( fM) is defined as the maximum frequency, where the OA provides an undesired AC output with the largest amplitude. Hence, fM for the VF can be expressed as in the following [3, 4]: fM =
1 SR 2π V out, max
ð5:198Þ
where Vout,max = min{Vr+, |Vr-|}. Operating frequency of any OA is given as [3, 4]. f ≤fM
V out, max V out
ð5:199Þ
where Vout ≤ Vout,max. Example 5.79 Find fM if the VF has SR = 107 V/s and Vout,max = 9 V, i.e., Vr+ = Vr- = 9 V. Solution 5.79 fM is calculated below. fM =
1 SR 107 = ffi 176:84 kHz 2π V out, max 2π × 9
ð5:200Þ
Example 5.80 Find the operating frequency if the VF has SR = 107 V/s, Vout, max = 9 V, Vout = 2 V, and fM ffi 176.84 kHz, i.e., Vr+ = -Vr- = 9 V. Solution 5.80 The operating frequency of the VF is evaluated as f ≤fM
V out, max 9 ffi 176:84 kHz ) f ≤ 795:77 kHz V out 2
ð5:201Þ
Example 5.81 Find SR and fM if the VF has Vout,max = 9 V, Vout = 5 V, and f ffi 1 MHz. In other words, Vr+ = -Vr- = 9 V. Solution 5.81 SR and fM are, respectively, found by SR = 2πf M V out, max = 2πfV out ) SR = 2π × 106 × 5 ffi 3:14 × 107 V=s fM =
SR π × 107 = ffi 555:56 kHz 2π × 9 2πV out, max
ð5:202aÞ ð5:202bÞ
Example 5.82 Find f3dB and fM if the non-inverting amplifier has Vout,max = 9 V, SR = 107 V/s, ft = 10 MHz, and 1 + R2/R1 = 100, i.e., Vr+ = -Vr- = 9 V.
150
5
Operational Amplifiers and Their Applications
Solution 5.82 f3dB and fM are, respectively, evaluated below. ft 10 MHz = = 100 kHz 100 1 þ RR21
ð5:203aÞ
SR 107 = ffi 176:84 kHz 2πV out, max 2π × 9
ð5:203bÞ
f 3dB = fM =
It is understood from above that if f ≤ fM is taken, Vout ≤ Vout,max. Also, Vin, max = 9 V/100 = 90 mV.
References 1. J.A. Svoboda, R.C. Dorf, Dorf’s Introduction to Electric Circuits, Global edition. (Wiley, 2018) 2. J.W. Nilsson, S. Riedel, Electric Circuits: Global Edition, 11th ed. (Pearson, 2018) 3. S. Franco, Design with Operational Amplifiers and Analog Integrated Circuits, 3rd ed. 4. A.S. Sedra, K.C. Smith, T.C. Carusone, V. Gaudet, Microelectronic Circuits, 8th edn. (Oxford University Press, New York, 2020) 5. K. Ogata, Modern Control Engineering, 5th edn. (Prentice Hall, Boston [etc.], 2010) ISBN-13: 9780136156734 6. R. Ford, F.E.J. Girling, Active filters and oscillators using simulated inductance. Electron. Lett. 2(2), 52 (1966) 7. K.R. Rao, S. Venkateswaran, Synthesis of inductors and gyrators with voltage-controlled voltage sources. Electron. Lett. 6(2), 29–30 (1970) 8. A.J. Prescott, Loss-compensated active gyrator using differential-input operational amplifiers. Electron. Lett. 7(2), 283–284 (1966) 9. http://www.chuacircuits.com/PDFs/AntoniouInductance-Simulation Circuit.pdf 10. B. Maundy, S.J. Gift, Active grounded inductor circuit. Int. J. Electron. 98(5), 555–567 (2011) 11. H.J. Orchard, A.N. Willson, New active-gyrator circuit. Electron. Lett. 13(10), 261–262 (1974) 12. P. Horowitz, W. Hill, The Art of Electronics, 2nd edn. (Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, 1989) ISBN 0-521-37095-7 13. N. Boutin, Two new single op-amp RC bridge-T oscillator circuits. IEE Proc. G (Electron. Circuit Syst.) 130(5), 222–224 (1983) 14. R. Genin, Realization of an all-pass transfer function using operational amplifiers. Proc. IEEE 56, 1746–1747 (1968) 15. R.E. Bach, Selecting RC values for active filters. Electronics 33, 82–85 (1960) 16. R.P. Sallen, E.L. Key, A practical method of designing RC active filters. IRE Trans. Circuit Theory 2(1), 74–85 (1955)
Chapter 6
Unity Gain Cells
6.1
Unity Gain Cells
Unity gain cells (UGCs), namely, current followers (CFs) and voltage followers (VFs), are main analog devices. They have been found wide application areas in the open literature [1–12].
6.2
CFs and Their Practices
CFs can be divided into four categories, plus-type single output CF (CF+), minus-type single output current follower (CF-), dual output CF (DO-CF), and multiple output CF (MO-CF). CF+ and CF- have two terminals, while DO-CF has three terminals. Also, DO-CF has both Z+ and Z- terminals. MO-CF has at least four terminals. Ideal model of the CF+ is given in Fig. 6.1, while the symbols of the CF+ are depicted in Fig. 6.2. The CF+ can be expressed with the following matrix equation: I Zþ VX
=
α 0
½I X ]
ð6:1Þ
Here, α is frequency-dependent nonideal gain and ideally equal to unity. Input and output impedances of the CF+ are ideally equal to zero and infinity, respectively. Therefore, the CF+ is suitable for current-mode (CM) circuits. Similarly, ideal model of the CF- is shown in Fig. 6.3, while the symbols of the CF- are demonstrated in Fig. 6.4. The CF- can be defined by the following matrix equation: The original version of the chapter has been revised. A correction to this chapter can be found at https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6_10 © The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2024, Corrected Publication 2024 E. Yuce, S. Minaei, Passive and Active Circuits by Example, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6_6
151
152
6
Fig. 6.1 Ideal model of the CF+
Unity Gain Cells
CF+
VX
IX
α IX
Fig. 6.2 The symbols of the CF+
VX
IX
VZ+
IZ+
CF
X
Z+
IZ+
VZ+
(a)
VX
IX
X
CF+
Z
IZ+
VZ+
(b)
Fig. 6.3 Ideal model of the CF-
VX
Fig. 6.4 The symbols of the CF-
CF-
IX
VX
IZ-
γI X
IX
X
CF
Z-
IZ-
VZ-
VZ-
(a)
VX
IX
X
CF-
Z
IZ-
VZ-
(b)
I Zþ VX
=
-γ 0
½I X ]
ð6:2Þ
where γ is frequency-dependent nonideal gain and ideally equal to unity. Note CF- has all the properties of the CF+ except current direction of the Z terminal.
6.2
CFs and Their Practices
Fig. 6.5 A simple VM circuit based on the CF+
153
Vin
X
CF+
Vout
Z
Z1 Z2
Fig. 6.6 A simple VM topology based on the CF-
Vin
X
CF-
Vout
Z
Z1 Z2
Example 6.1 Analyze the simple voltage-mode (VM) circuits in Figs. 6.5 and 6.6. Solution 6.1 The simple structures based on CF+ and CF- are, respectively, exhibited in Figs. 6.5 and 6.6. Analysis of the simple topology based on CF+ is carried out as follows: I Zþ = αI X
ð6:3aÞ
V in = IX Z1
ð6:3bÞ
V out = - I Zþ Z2
ð6:3cÞ
From above equations, the following transfer function (TF) is easily obtained: α
V in V V Z = - out ) H v = out = - α 2 Z1 Z2 V in Z1
ð6:4Þ
Ideally, TF in Eq. (6.4) turns to Hv =
V out Z =- 2 V in Z1
ð6:5Þ
Likewise, analysis of the simple topology based on CF- is achieved as I Z - = - γI X
ð6:6aÞ
154 Fig. 6.7 An inverting VM amplifier/attenuator
Vin
X
R1
CF+
6
Unity Gain Cells
Z
Vout R2
Fig. 6.8 A non-inverting VM amplifier/attenuator
Vin
X
CF-
Vout
Z
R1 R2
V in = IX Z1
ð6:6bÞ
V out = - IZ Z2
ð6:6cÞ
From above equations, the following TF is easily obtained: γ
V in V out V Z = ) H v = out = γ 2 Z1 Z2 V in Z1
ð6:7Þ
From above equation, TF ideally converts to Hv =
V out Z = 2 V in Z1
ð6:8Þ
By appropriate choice of the impedances, Z1 and Z2 given in Figs. 6.5 and 6.6, the following topologies are obtained. (a) In Fig. 6.7, an inverting VM amplifier/attenuator can be easily obtained by taking Z1 = R1 and Z2 = R2 of the circuit in Fig. 6.5. Thus, TF is evaluated as Hv =
V out R =- 2 V in R1
ð6:9Þ
(b) In Fig. 6.8, a non-inverting VM amplifier/attenuator can be easily obtained by taking Z1 = R1 and Z2 = R2 of the circuit in Fig. 6.6. Therefore, TF is evaluated by
6.2
CFs and Their Practices
155
Fig. 6.9 An inverting VM integrator
Vin
X
CF+
Vout
Z
R C
Fig. 6.10 A non-inverting VM integrator
Vin
X
CF-
Vout
Z
R C
Fig. 6.11 An inverting VM differentiator structure
Vin
X
CF+
Vout
Z
C R
Hv =
V out R = 2 V in R1
ð6:10Þ
(c) In Fig. 6.9, an inverting VM integrator can be easily obtained by taking Z1 = R1 and Z2 = 1/(sC) of the structure in Fig. 6.5. Hence, TF is calculated as Hv =
V out 1 =V in sCR
ð6:11Þ
(d) In Fig. 6.10, a non-inverting VM integrator circuit can be easily obtained by taking Z1 = R1 and Z2 = 1/(sC) of the structure in Fig. 6.6. As a result, TF is calculated by Hv =
V out 1 = V in sCR
ð6:12Þ
(e) In Fig. 6.11, an inverting VM differentiator circuit can be easily obtained by taking Z1 = 1/(sC) and Z2 = R of the structure in Fig. 6.5. Hence, TF is computed below.
156 Fig. 6.12 A non-inverting VM differentiator
Vin
X
CF-
6
Unity Gain Cells
Z
Vout
C R
Vin
CF+
X
Vout
Z
R1 R2
C
Fig. 6.13 An inverting first-order VM LPF Fig. 6.14 A non-inverting first-order VM LPF
Vin
X
CF-
Vout
Z
R1 C
Hv =
V out = - sCR V in
R2
ð6:13Þ
(f) In Fig. 6.12, a non-inverting VM differentiator topology can be easily obtained by taking Z1 = 1/(sC) and Z2 = R of the circuit in Fig. 6.6. Consequently, TF is computed by Hv =
V out = sCR V in
ð6:14Þ
(g) In Fig. 6.13, an inverting first-order VM low-pass filter (LPF) can be easily obtained by taking Z1 = R1 and Z2 = R2//(1/(sC)) of the structure in Fig. 6.5. Thus, TF is found below. Hv =
1 V out R =- 2 V in R1 sCR2 þ 1
ð6:15Þ
(h) In Fig. 6.14, a non-inverting first-order VM LPF can be easily obtained by
6.2
CFs and Their Practices
Fig. 6.15 An inverting first-order VM HPF
157
Vin
X
R1
CF+
Vout
Z
C R2
Fig. 6.16 A non-inverting first-order VM HPF
Vin
X
R1
CF-
Vout
Z
C R2
choosing Z1 = R1 and Z2 = R2//(1/(sC)) of the circuit of Fig. 6.6. Hence, TF is found as Hv =
1 V out R = 2 V in R1 sCR2 þ 1
ð6:16Þ
(i) In Fig. 6.15, an inverting first-order VM high-pass filter (HPF) can be easily obtained by taking Z1 = R1 + 1/(sC) and Z2 = R2 of the structure in Fig. 6.5. As a result, TF is computed below. Hv =
sCR1 V out R =- 2 V in R1 sCR1 þ 1
ð6:17Þ
(j) In Fig. 6.16, a non-inverting first-order VM HPF can be easily obtained by choosing the impedances Z1 = R1 + 1/(sC) and Z2 = R2 of the structure of Fig. 6.6. Thus, TF is calculated as Hv =
V out R sCR1 = 2 V in R1 sCR1 þ 1
ð6:18Þ
Example 6.2 Design a VM analog adder circuits based on a single output CF. Solution 6.2 CF+ and CF- based VM analog adders are, respectively, depicted in Figs. 6.17 and 6.18. Outputs of these circuits are, respectively, indicated below.
158 Fig. 6.17 An inverting VM analog adder based on the CF+
V1
X
CF+
6
Unity Gain Cells
Z
Vout
R1 V2
RT
R2 Vn Rn Fig. 6.18 A non-inverting VM analog adder based on the CF-
V1
X
CF-
Vout
Z
R1 V2
RT
R2 Vn Rn Fig. 6.19 An inverting first-order CM APF based on the CF+
C
Vtest
X
CF
Z+
R
Iin
Iout
n
V out = i=1 n
V out = i=1
RT V Ri i
RT V Ri i
ð6:19aÞ ð6:19bÞ
Example 6.3 Find TF of the inverting first-order current-mode (CM) all-pass filter (APF) shown in Fig. 6.19 [1]. Solution 6.3 Analysis of the inverting first-order CM APF based on the CF+ in Fig. 6.19 is performed as follows:
6.2
CFs and Their Practices
159
Fig. 6.20 A non-inverting first-order CM APF based on the CF+
R
X
CF
Z+
C Iin
Iout
Fig. 6.21 An inverting first-order VM APF based on the CF+
C
R1 Vin
X
R2
CF
Z+
1 1 and I out = V test sC R R 1 1 V test sC R × sC I out R R = = Hi = 1 1 I in V test sC þ R × sC þ R R ðsCR - 1Þ × ð- 1Þ × ð- 1Þ 1 - sCR = =1 þ sCR 1 þ sCR
Vout
I in = V test sC þ
ð6:20Þ
Example 6.4 Find TF of the non-inverting first-order CM APF depicted in Fig. 6.20, which is obtained from one given in [1] by RC-CR transformation. Solution 6.4 Analysis of the inverting first-order CM APF based on the CF+ in Fig. 6.20 is found below. H i ðsÞ =
I out 1 - sCR = I in 1 þ sCR
ð6:21Þ
Example 6.5 Find TF of the inverting first-order VM APF demonstrated in Fig. 6.21 [2]. Solution 6.5 TF of this topology is given below. Hv =
V out =V in
R1 R2
- 1 - sCR1 1 þ sCR1
ð6:22Þ
160 Fig. 6.22 An inverting first-order APF based on the CF+
6
Unity Gain Cells
Z+
Vout
C
Vin
CF
X
R1
R2
If R1 = 2R2 is taken, the circuit in Fig. 6.21 behaves like a CF+ based inverting firstorder VM APF. Analysis of the structure in Fig. 6.21 is achieved by using the following steps: V in 1 = ðV in - V out Þ sC þ R2 R1
ð6:23aÞ
R1 V in = ðV in - V out ÞðsCR1 þ 1Þ R2 ðsCR1 þ 1ÞV out = V in ðsCR1 þ 1Þ ðsCR1 þ 1ÞV out = V in sCR1 þ 1 ðsCR1 þ 1ÞV out = - V in V out =V in
R1 R2
R1 V in R2
ð6:23bÞ ð6:23cÞ
R1 × ð- 1Þ × ð- 1Þ R2
ð6:23dÞ
R1 - 1 - sCR1 R2
ð6:23eÞ
- 1 - sCR1 1 þ sCR1
ð6:23fÞ
Example 6.6 Find TF of the inverting first-order VM APF shown in Fig. 6.22 [2]. Solution 6.6 TF of this circuit is evaluated as Hv =
V out 1 - sCR1 = - R1 V in R2 þ sCR1
ð6:24Þ
If R1 = R2 is chosen, the topology in Fig. 6.22 behaves like a CF+ based inverting first-order VM APF. Analysis of the structure in Fig. 6.22 is accomplished by using the following steps:
6.2
CFs and Their Practices
161
Fig. 6.23 An inverting first-order VM APF based on the CF+
C
R2 Vin
X
R1
sCV in -
V out
Vout
ð6:25aÞ
V in V out = þ sCV out R1 R2
ð6:25bÞ
V in V out þ sCV out × R1 × R1 = R1 R2
V in ðsCR1 - 1Þ = V out V out
Z+
V in V out = R1 R2
ðV in - V out ÞsC sCV in -
CF
R1 þ sCR1 R2
R1 þ sCR1 = V in ðsCR1 - 1Þ × ð- 1Þ × ð- 1Þ R2
V 1 - sCR1 R1 þ sCR1 = - V in ð1 - sCR1 Þ ) out = - R1 R2 V in R2 þ sCR1
ð6:25cÞ ð6:25dÞ ð6:25eÞ ð6:25fÞ
Example 6.7 Find TF of the inverting first-order APF depicted in Fig. 6.23 [2]. Solution 6.7 TF of this circuit is computed as follows: Hv =
V out 1 - sCR1 = - 2R1 V in R2 þ sCR1
ð6:26Þ
If R2 = 2R1 is taken, the circuit in Fig. 6.23 behaves like a CF+ based inverting firstorder VM APF. Analysis of the structure in Fig. 6.23 is carried out by using the following steps: V V in V out þ = ðV in - V out ÞsC - out R1 R2 R2
ð6:27aÞ
V in 2V out þ = ðV in - V out ÞsC R1 R2
ð6:27bÞ
V 2V out þ V out sC = sCV in - in R2 R1
ð6:27cÞ
162
6
Unity Gain Cells
R1
Vin
X
R2
CF
Z+
Vout
C
Fig. 6.24 A non-inverting first-order VM APF based on the CF+
R1 ×
2 1 þ sC V out = R1 × sC V R2 R1 in
ð6:27dÞ
2R1 þ sCR1 V out = ðsCR1 - 1ÞV in R2
ð6:27eÞ
2R1 þ sCR1 V out = ð- 1Þ × ð- 1Þ × ðsCR1 - 1ÞV in R2
ð6:27fÞ
V 1 - sCR1 2R1 þ sCR1 V out = - ð1 - sCR1 ÞV in ) out = - 2R1 R2 V in R2 þ sCR1
ð6:27gÞ
Example 6.8 Find TF of the non-inverting first-order APF depicted in Fig. 6.24 [3]. Solution 6.8 TF of this structure is evaluated below. Hv =
1 - sC ðR1 - R2 Þ V out = 1 þ sCR2 V in
ð6:28Þ
If R1 = 2R2 is taken, the topology in Fig. 6.24 behaves like a CF+ based non-inverting first-order VM APF. Analysis of the structure in Fig. 6.24 is accomplished by using the following steps: V in V - V out = in 1 R1 R2 þ sC
ð6:29aÞ
V in sC V - V out V in × sC = = in 1 R1 × sC sCR2 þ 1 R2 þ sC
ð6:29bÞ
V in sC V - V out × R1 × R1 = in R1 sCR2 þ 1
ð6:29cÞ
V in sCR1 = V in - V out sCR2 þ 1
ð6:29dÞ
V in sCR1 sCR2 þ 1
ð6:29eÞ
V out = V in -
6.2
CFs and Their Practices
163
V2
X
CF
Z+
CF
X
(1)
R1
Vout
Z+
(2)
R3
V1
R2 Fig. 6.25 An IA implementation based on the two CF+s
VX
(2)
(1)
IX
X
CF
Z+
X
CF
Z+
IZ-
VZ-
Fig. 6.26 Realization of the CF- by using two CF+s Fig. 6.27 Symbol of the DO-CF
IZ+ Z+
VX
X
IX
VX
V out =
CF Z-
CF
Fig. 6.28 Ideal model of the DO-CF
IX
α IX
VZ+
IZ-
IZ+
γ IX
sCR2 þ 1 sCR1 1 þ sCR2 - sCR1 V V ) V out = V in sCR2 þ 1 sCR2 þ 1 in sCR2 þ 1 in
IZ-
VZ-
VZ+ VZ-
ð6:29fÞ
Example 6.9 Realize an instrumentation amplifier (IA) based on two CF+s. Solution 6.9 Realization of the IA is depicted in Fig. 6.25 [4], where R2 = R1 is taken. Therefore, output voltage of this IA is calculated by V out =
R3 ðV - V 1 Þ R1 2
ð6:30Þ
Example 6.10 Implement a CF- by using CF+s. Solution 6.10 Implementation of the CF- by using two CF+s is shown in Fig. 6.26. The electrical symbol of the DO-CF is demonstrated in Fig. 6.27, while ideal model
164
6
Fig. 6.29 Realization of the floating current source based on the DO-CF
Unity Gain Cells
Iout Z+
Vin
a
CF
X
R
Z-
Fig. 6.30 The symbol of the floating current source
Iout
b
a
Iout b
(1)
X
Iin
Z1
CF+
(2)
Vtest
Z2
X
R
Z1
Iout
CF+ Z2
C
Fig. 6.31 Non-inverting first-order CM APF
of the DO-CF is given in Fig. 6.28. This DO-CF can be defined by the following matrix equation: I Zþ IZ -
=
α - γ ½I X ]
ð6:31Þ
0
VX
Example 6.11 Design a floating current source based on the DO-CF. Solution 6.11 The floating current source can be implemented by using a voltage source, a resistor, and a DO-CF as depicted in Fig. 6.29. The symbol of this floating current source is shown in Fig. 6.30. The current, Iout, in Figs. 6.29 and 6.30 is evaluated as follows: I out =
V in R
ð6:32Þ
6.2
CFs and Their Practices
Vin
165
Zin
Z-
Z-
Iin
(1)
CF Z+
X
R1
(2)
Z-
CF
Vtest R2
X
C
Fig. 6.32 A positive lossless SGI
Example 6.12 Find the TF of the CM topology in Fig. 6.31 [5]. Solution 6.12 The circuit of Fig. 6.31 is analyzed as V test sC þ
1 - I in R = - I in ) V test = sCR þ 1 R
ð6:33Þ
From equation indicated in (6.33), output current, Iout is found by I out = - I in -
2V test 1 - sCR = I R 1 þ sCR in
ð6:34Þ
I out 1 - sCR = I in 1 þ sCR
ð6:35Þ
Hence, the TF is calculated below. H ðsÞ =
Example 6.13 Find the input impedance of the positive lossless simulated grounded inductor (SGI) in Fig. 6.32 [6]. Solution 6.13 The circuit given in Fig. 6.32 is analyzed with the two equations as given below. It is considered that the current flowing into the X terminal of the CF is equal to the current extracted from the Z- terminal of the same CF. I in =
- V test R2
V in V = - V test sC ) V test = - in R1 sCR1
ð6:36aÞ ð6:36bÞ
If Vtest in Eq. (6.36b) is replaced instead of equation denoted in (6.36a), the following input impedance is obtained:
166
6
I in =
6.3
Unity Gain Cells
V in V ) Z in = in = sCR1 R2 sCR1 R2 I in
ð6:37Þ
VFs and Their Applications
The symbol of the voltage follower (VF) is given in Fig. 6.33, while ideal model of the VF is depicted in Fig. 6.34. The VF can be defined by the following matrix equation: IY 0 = VX β
0 0
VY IX
ð6:38Þ
where β is frequency dependent nonideal voltage gain, which is ideally equal to unity. Note In Fig. 6.34, Rin is ideally equal to infinity. Example 6.14 Find the current TF of the VF-based simple circuit in Fig. 6.35. Solution 6.14 The analysis of the circuit in Fig. 6.35 is performed by using the following three equations: VX = VY
ð6:39aÞ
Fig. 6.33 The symbol of the VF
VY
Y
IY
Fig. 6.34 Ideal model of the VF
VF
X
IX
VX
VF VY
IY
Rin
+ V _ Y
IX
VX
6.3
VFs and Their Applications
167
Fig. 6.35 A simple CM topology based on the VF
VF
Y
X
Z2
Z1
Iin
Iout
Fig. 6.36 The VF-based second-order VM multifunction filter
Y
VF
(1)
Vo1
X
C2
R1 C1 X
Vi1
VF
Y
(2)
R2
Vo2 Vi2
I in =
VY Z1
ð6:39bÞ
I out =
VX Z2
ð6:39cÞ
From above equations, the following TF is obtained: I in Z 1 = I out Z 2 ) H i =
I out Z = 1 I in Z2
ð6:40Þ
So, various first-order current TFs based on the selection of Z1 and Z2 are obtained. Example 6.15 Find the voltage responses of the VF-based second-order multifunction filter in Fig. 6.36 [7]. Solution 6.15 The analysis of the circuit in Fig. 6.36 is performed by using the following two equations: ðV i1 - V o1 ÞsC1 =
V o1 - V o2 R1
ð6:41aÞ
ðV o1 - V o2 ÞsC 2 =
V o2 - V i2 R2
ð6:41bÞ
168
6
Unity Gain Cells
From equations denoted in (6.41), if Vi1 = 0 is chosen, the following LPF TF is found as follows: 1 V o1 = V i2 C 1 C 2 R1 R2 s2 þ C1 R1 s þ 1
ð6:42Þ
Similarly, if Vi2 = 0 is taken, the following HPF TF is evaluated by C1 C2 R1 R2 s2 V o2 = V i1 C 1 C 2 R1 R2 s2 þ C1 R1 s þ 1
6.4
ð6:43Þ
CF and VF-Based Circuits
In this section, CF and VF-based structures are treated with several examples. Example 6.16 Find the phase and magnitude of the impedance of the parallel lossy SGI in Fig. 6.37 [8]. Also, find the useful operating frequency range of this SGI. Solution 6.16 The analysis of the topology in Fig. 6.37 is achieved by using the following two equations: I in =
V in - V test V in þ R1 R2
ð6:44aÞ
V in = - sCV test R2
ð6:44bÞ
From equation indicated in (6.44b), Vtest is computed below. V test = -
V in sCR2
ð6:45Þ
If Vtest is replaced in Eq. (6.44a), Iin is calculated as
R1
Iin
Vin
R2
X
CF
Z+
Vtest
(1)
(2)
C
Zin Fig. 6.37 The UGC-based parallel lossy SGI
Y
VF
X
6.4
CF and VF-Based Circuits
I in =
169
V in V in þ sCR V 1 1 1 2 þ in = V in þ þ R1 R2 R1 R2 sCR1 R2
ð6:46Þ
From equation given in (6.46), the admittance of the structure in Fig. 6.37 is found as in the following: Y in =
I in 1 1 1 = þ þ V in R1 R2 sCR1 R2 1 1 = þ Req sLeq
ð6:47Þ
Here, Leq = CR1R2 and Req = R1//R2 = R1R2/(R1 + R2). In other words, the impedance in s domain is evaluated as Z in ðsÞ = ðsCR1 R2 Þ==R1 ==R2
ð6:48Þ
On the other hand, the impedance of the circuit of Fig. 6.37 in the frequency domain is found as Z in ðωÞ = ðjωCR1 R2 Þ==R1 ==R2
ð6:49Þ
The phase and magnitude of the impedance of the parallel lossy SGI in Fig. 6.37 are, respectively, computed by ∠Z in ðωÞ = jZ in ðωÞj =
π - tan - 1 ðωCðR1 þ R2 ÞÞ 2 ωCR1 R2 ðR1 ==R2 Þ ðωCR1 R2 Þ2 þ ðR1 ==R2 Þ2
ð6:50aÞ ð6:50bÞ
It is seen from above equations that if the following condition is met, the circuit in Fig. 6.37 operates as a lossless inductor. 1 R1 R2 > > ωCR1 R2 ) ≥ 10ωC R1 þ R2 R1 þ R2
ð6:51Þ
From equation in (6.51), the operating frequency range is found below. f≤
0:1 1 × 2π C ðR1 þ R2 Þ
ð6:52Þ
Example 6.17 Find the phase and magnitude of the impedance of parallel lossy SGI in Fig. 6.38 [9]. Also, find the useful operating frequency range of this SGI.
170
6
Unity Gain Cells
R1
Iin
Vin
Y
VF
X
X
R2
(1)
CF
Vtest
Z+
(2)
Y
VF
X
(3)
C
Zin Fig. 6.38 The UGC-based another parallel lossy SGI
Solution 6.17 The analysis of the topology in Fig. 6.38 is carried out by using the following two equations: V in - V test R1
ð6:53aÞ
V in = - sCV test R2
ð6:53bÞ
I in =
From equation indicated in (6.53b), Vtest is computed below. V test = -
V in sCR2
ð6:54Þ
If Vtest is replaced in Eq. (6.53a), Iin is computed by I in =
V in V in þ sCR 1 1 2 = V in þ R1 R1 sCR1 R2
ð6:55Þ
From equation given in (6.55), the admittance of the topology of Fig. 6.38 is found as Y in =
I in 1 1 = þ V in R1 sCR1 R2 1 1 = þ Req sLeq
ð6:56Þ
where Leq = CR1R2 and Req = R1. In other words, the impedance in s domain is computed below. Z in ðsÞ = ðsCR1 R2 Þ==R1
ð6:57Þ
On the other hand, the impedance of the circuit of Fig. 6.38 in the frequency domain is found as follows:
6.4
CF and VF-Based Circuits
171
Z-
CF
X
R1
(1)
Iin
Vin
Y
VF
X
X
R2
(2)
CF
Vtest
Z+
Y
(3)
VF
X
(4)
C
Zin Fig. 6.39 The UGC-based positive lossless SGI
Z in ðωÞ = ðjωCR1 R2 Þ==R1
ð6:58Þ
The phase and magnitude of the impedance of the another parallel lossy SGI in Fig. 6.38 are, respectively, calculated as ∠Z in ðωÞ = jZ in ðωÞj =
π - tan - 1 ðωCR2 Þ 2 ωCR21 R2 ðωCR1 R2 Þ2 þ R21
ð6:59aÞ ð6:59bÞ
It is observed from above equations that if the following condition is met, the circuit in Fig. 6.38 operates as a lossless inductor. R1 > > ωCR1 R2 )
1 1 > > ωC ) ≥ 10ωC R2 R2
ð6:60Þ
From equation in (6.60), the operating frequency range is found as follows: f≤
0:1 1 × 2π CR2
ð6:61Þ
Example 6.18 Find the impedance of the positive SGI in Fig. 6.39 [10]. Solution 6.18 The analysis of the topology in Fig. 6.39 is accomplished by using the following two equations: I in = -
V test R1
V in = - sCV test R2 From equation indicated in (6.62b), Vtest is evaluated as
ð6:62aÞ ð6:62bÞ
172
6
Unity Gain Cells
Z1
Iin
Vin
X
Z2
Zin
CF
Z-
Vtest
Y
(1)
VF
X
(2)
Z3
Fig. 6.40 The UGC-based negative lossless SGI
V test = -
V in sCR2
ð6:63Þ
If Vtest is replaced in Eq. (6.62a), Iin is computed as in the following: I in =
V in sCR2
R1
= V in
1 sCR1 R2
ð6:64Þ
From equation in (6.64), the impedance of the topology of Fig. 6.39 is calculated as Z in =
V in = sCR1 R2 = sLeq I in
ð6:65Þ
where Leq = CR1R2. Example 6.19 Find the impedance of the negative lossless SGI in Fig. 6.40 [11]. Solution 6.19 The analysis of the topology in Fig. 6.40 is carried out by using the following two equations: I in =
V in - V test Z1
ð6:66aÞ
V - V test V in = - in Z2 Z3
ð6:66bÞ
From equation indicated in (6.66b), Vin - Vtest is found below. V in - V test = - V in
Z3 Z2
ð6:67Þ
If Vin - Vtest in Eq. (6.67) is replaced in (6.66a), Iin is evaluated as I in =
- V in ZZ 32 Z = - V in 3 Z1 Z1Z2
From above equation, the impedance is computed as follows:
ð6:68Þ
6.4
CF and VF-Based Circuits
173
Z1
Iin
Vin
(2)
X
VF
Z+
Vtest
(3)
Y
VF
X
Z2
(1)
Y
CF
X
Zin
Z3
Fig. 6.41 The UGC-based positive lossless SGI
Z in =
Z1Z2 V in =I in Z3
ð6:69Þ
Here, if Z1 = R1, Z2 = R2, and Z3 = 1/(sC) are chosen, a negative lossless SGI is obtained. Example 6.20 Find the impedance of the positive lossless SGI in Fig. 6.41 [12]. Solution 6.20 The analysis of the topology in Fig. 6.41 is performed by using the following two equations: V in - V test Z1
ð6:70aÞ
V in V in - V test = Z2 Z3
ð6:70bÞ
I in =
From equation indicated in (6.70b), Vin - Vtest is found as follows: V in - V test = V in
Z3 Z2
ð6:71Þ
If Vin - Vtest in Eq. (6.71) is replaced in (6.70a), Iin is calculated by I in =
V in ZZ 32 Z = V in 3 Z1 Z1Z2
ð6:72Þ
From above equation, the impedance is computed below. Z in =
V in Z 1 Z 2 = I in Z3
ð6:73Þ
where if Z1 = R1, Z2 = R2, and Z3 = 1/(sC) are taken, a positive lossless SGI is obtained.
174
6
Unity Gain Cells
References 1. S. Maheshwari, A new current-mode current-controlled all-pass section. J. Circuit. Syst. Comput. 16(2), 181–189 (2007) 2. A. Toker, S. Ozcan, H. Kuntman, O. Cicekoglu, Supplementary all-pass sections with reduced number of passive elements using a single current conveyor. Int. J. Electron. 88(9), 969–976 (2001) 3. O. Cicekoglu, H. Kuntman, S. Berk, All-pass filters using a single current conveyor. Int. J. Electron. 86(8), 947–955 (1999) 4. L. Safari, G. Ferri, S. Minaei, V. Stornelli, Current-Mode Instrumentation Amplifiers (Springer, 2019) 5. L. Safari, S. Minaei, E. Yuce, CMOS first-order current-mode all-pass filter with electronic tuning capability and its applications. J. Circuit. Syst. Comput. (JCSC) 22(3), 17 (2013) 6. E. S. Erdoğan, Active Filter Design with Unity Gain Current Cells (MSc thesis, Bogazici University, 2004) 7. F. Yucel, E. Yuce, A new voltage mode multifunctional filter using only two voltage followers and a minimum number of passive elements. J. Circuit. Syst. Comput. (JCSC) 24(6), 16 (2015) 8. A. Fabre, O. Saaid, F. Wiest, C. Boucheron, Low power current-mode second-order bandpass IF filter. IEEE Trans. Circuit. Syst. II Analog Digital Sign. Process. 44(6), 436–446 (1997) 9. H. Alpaslan, E. Yuce, Current-mode biquadratic universal filter design with two terminal unity gain cells. Radioengineering 21(1), 304–311 (2012) 10. H. Alzaher, N. Tasadduq, CMOS digitally programmable inductance. In 2006 International conference on microelectronics (IEEE, 2006), pp. 138–141 11. A.U. Keskin, A. Toker, A NIC with impedance scaling properties using unity gain cells. Analog Integr. Circ. Sig. Process 41(1), 85–87 (2004) 12. H. Alpaslan, E. Yuce, New grounded inductor simulator using unity gain cells. Indian J. Pure Appl. Phys. 51(09), 651–656 (2013)
Chapter 7
Unity Gain Inverting Amplifiers and Negative Impedance Converters
7.1
Introduction
Unity gain inverting amplifiers (UGIAs) and negative impedance converters (NICs) are main analog devices. They have been found wide application realms in the related open literature [1–9].
7.2
UGIAs
The electrical symbol of the UGIA is depicted in Fig. 7.1, while ideal model of the UGIA is demonstrated in Fig. 7.2. The UGIA with nonideal voltage gain is expressed as follows: IY = VX
0 -β
0 0
VY IX
ð7:1Þ
Here, IX is an arbitrary current depending on the load connected the X terminal of the UGIA. β is frequency dependent nonideal voltage gain, ideally equal to unity. Also, Rin in Fig. 7.2 is ideally equal to infinity. Example 7.1 Design a simple current-mode (CM) circuit for realizing different transfer functions (TFs) based on the UGIA. Solution 7.1 The simple circuit based on the UGIA is shown in Fig. 7.3. Analysis of the simple topology is carried out as below. V X = - βV Y
© The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2024 E. Yuce, S. Minaei, Passive and Active Circuits by Example, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6_7
ð7:2aÞ
175
176
7
Unity Gain Inverting Amplifiers and Negative Impedance Converters
Fig. 7.1 The electrical symbol of the UGIA
VY
-1
Y
IY
X
VX
IX
Fig. 7.2 Ideal model of the UGIA
VY
IY
Rin
Fig. 7.3 The CM simple circuit based on the UGIA Y
_ +
-1
Z1
Iin
IX
VY
VX
X
Z2
Iout
I in =
VY Z1
ð7:2bÞ
I out =
VX Z2
ð7:2cÞ
From above equations, the following CM TF is obtained: I in Z 1 =
- I out Z 2 I βZ ) H i = out = - 1 β I in Z2
ð7:3Þ
By selecting different elements for Z1 and Z2, various types of TFs can be obtained. Example 7.2 Design a VF by using the UGIAs. Solution 7.2 The VF realization by using two UGIAs is demonstrated in Fig. 7.4. Example 7.3 Find the TF of the first-order voltage-mode (VM) APF based on a single UGIA [1], which is given in Fig. 7.5.
7.2
UGIAs
VY
177
IY
Y
-1
Y
X
(1)
-1
X
IX
(2)
VX
Fig. 7.4 The VF implementation with two UGIAs Fig. 7.5 The first-order VM APF using a single UGIA
Vin
Y
-1
R
X
Vout
C
Fig. 7.6 Another first-order VM circuit employing a single UGIA
Vout R1
Vin
R2
Vtest
R
Y
-1
X
C
Solution 7.3 By applying the KVL for the circuit in Fig. 7.5, the following equation is obtained: - V in - V out = ðV out - V in ÞsC R
ð7:4Þ
Rearranging the equation denoted in (7.4), the equation given below is obtained. - V in - V out = ðV out - V in ÞsCR ) - V in þ V in sCR = V out þ V out sCR
ð7:5Þ
From above equation, TF of the VM APF is found as V in ð- 1 þ sCRÞ = V out ð1 þ sCRÞ )
V out - 1 þ sCR 1 - sCR = =V in 1 þ sCR 1 þ sCR
ð7:6Þ
Example 7.4 Find the TF of another first-order VM topology based on a single UGIA [2], which is depicted in Fig. 7.6.
178
7
Unity Gain Inverting Amplifiers and Negative Impedance Converters
Solution 7.4 By applying the KVL for the circuit in Fig. 7.6, the following equation is obtained: V in - V out V þ V test = out R1 R2
ð7:7Þ
Here, Vtest is evaluated as V test =
1 V 1 þ sCR in
ð7:8Þ
If R1 = 2R2 is taken for the equations indicated in (7.7), the following equation is obtained: V þ V test V - V out V in - V out = out ) in = V out þ V test 2R2 R2 2
ð7:9Þ
Rearrangement of the equation in (7.9), the equation given below is obtained. V in - V out V V in V V in = V out þ ) in = out þ V out 2 1 þ sCR 2 1 þ sCR 2
ð7:10Þ
Further arranging the equation in (7.10), the following equation is obtained as 1 2 V in
þ 12 sCRV in - V in 1 1 - sCR 1 3 =V = V out þ 1 = V out 1 þ sCR 2 1 þ sCR in 2 2
ð7:11Þ
Finally, the following first-order VM APF TF is found. 1 1 - sCR V out =V in 3 1 þ sCR
ð7:12Þ
Example 7.5 Find the TFs of the first-order CM topology based on a single UGIA [3], which is shown in Fig. 7.7. Also, R1 = R2 = R and C1 = C2 = C are chosen. Solution 7.5 Analysis of the first-order CM filter is accomplished by the following five equations: I in = V test sC þ
1 I in RI in ) V test = = R sC þ R1 sCR þ 1 I LP1 =
V test R
I HP1 = V test sC
ð7:13aÞ ð7:13bÞ ð7:13cÞ
7.3
NICs
179
Vtest
-1
Y
X
C1 Iin
R1
R2 IHP1
ILP2
ILP1
C2
IAP1
IHP2
IAP2 Fig. 7.7 The first-order CM structure consisting of a single UGIA
I LP2 = -
V test R
I HP2 = - sCV test
ð7:13dÞ ð7:13eÞ
From above equations, the following output currents are obtained: I LP1 =
1 I 1 þ sCR in
ð7:14aÞ
I HP1 =
sCR I 1 þ sCR in
ð7:14bÞ
I LP2 = -
1 I 1 þ sCR in
ð7:14cÞ
I HP2 = -
sCR I 1 þ sCR in
ð7:14dÞ
I AP1 = I HP1 þ I LP2 = I AP2 = I LP1 þ I HP2 =
7.3
1 - sCR I 1 þ sCR in
1 - sCR I 1 þ sCR in
ð7:14eÞ ð7:14fÞ
NICs
The symbol of the NIC is given in Fig. 7.8 [4]. NIC can be divided into two subcategories, current NIC (INIC) and voltage NIC (VNIC). The symbols of the INIC and VNIC are, respectively, shown in Figs. 7.9 and 7.10.
180
7
Unity Gain Inverting Amplifiers and Negative Impedance Converters
Fig. 7.8 The symbol of the NIC
V1
Fig. 7.9 The symbol of the INIC
I1
V1
Fig. 7.10 The symbol of the VNIC
I1
V1
I1
Fig. 7.11 The first-order VM circuit based on the INIC
NIC
2
1
INIC
2
1
VNIC
2
1
I2
I2
I2
V2
V2
V2
C
Vin
1
R1
INIC
Vout
2
R2
INIC and VNIC are, respectively, expressed by the following matrix equations: I2 1 = V1 0 I2 = V1
-1 0
0 1 0 -1
I1 V2
ð7:15aÞ I1 V2
ð7:15bÞ
Example 7.6 Find the TF of the first-order VM topology based on a single INIC [5], which is shown in Fig. 7.11. Solution 7.6 The topology of Fig. 7.11 is analyzed as in the following: ðV in - V out ÞsC V in sC -
V in - V out V = out R1 R2
V in V out V = - out þ V out sC R1 R2 R1
ð7:16aÞ ð7:16bÞ
7.3
NICs
181
Fig. 7.12 The negative grounded impedance based on a single INIC
Vin
Iin
1
INIC
Vin
2
Iin
Z(s)
Zin
R1 × V in sC -
1 1 1 þ sC = R1 × V out R2 R1 R1
V in ðsCR1 - 1Þ = V out ð- 1Þ × ð- 1Þ × V in ðsCR1 - 1Þ = V out
R1 - 1 þ sCR1 R2
ð7:16cÞ ð7:16dÞ
R1 - 1 þ sCR1 = R2 ð7:16eÞ
- V in ð1 - sCR1 Þ Thus, output voltage is found as V out = -
R1 R2
1 - sCR1 V in - 1 þ sCR1
ð7:17Þ
If R1 = 2R2 is taken, TF of the structure in Fig. 7.11 is computed as follows: V out = -
1 - sCR1 V 1 - sCR1 V ) out = 1 þ sCR1 in V in 1 þ sCR1
ð7:18Þ
Example 7.7 Find the input impedance of the circuit depicted in Fig. 7.12. Solution 7.7 After analysis of the topology of Fig. 7.12, the following input impedance is found as Z in =
- I in Z ðsÞ V in = = - Z ðs Þ I in I in
ð7:19Þ
Example 7.8 Find the input impedance of the structure in Fig. 7.13. Solution 7.8 After analysis of the circuit in Fig. 7.13, the following input impedance is found by
182
7
Vin
Iin
Unity Gain Inverting Amplifiers and Negative Impedance Converters
1
Z1
INIC
2
Z2
Zin
Fig. 7.13 A topology based on a single INIC Fig. 7.14 The positive parallel lossy SGI based on a single INIC
Vin
Iin
1
R
INIC
2
C
R
Zin C
Vin
1
Iin
INIC
R
2
R
Zin Fig. 7.15 The negative parallel lossy SGI based on a single INIC
Z in = Z 1 - Z 2
ð7:20Þ
If Z1 = R and Z2 = R//(1/(sC)) in Fig. 7.13 are taken, a positive parallel lossy simulated grounded inductor (SGI) in Fig. 7.14 is obtained. This parallel lossy SGI is expressed as [6] Z in = R== sCR2
ð7:21Þ
If Z1 = R//(1/(sC)) and Z2 = R in Fig. 7.13 are selected, a negative parallel lossy SGI in Fig. 7.15 is obtained. This negative parallel lossy SGI is expressed by [6]
7.3
NICs
Fig. 7.16 Another circuit based on a single INIC
183
Vin
1
Iin
INIC
2
Z2
Z1
Zin
Fig. 7.17 The positive series lossy SGI based on a single INIC
Vin
1
Iin
INIC
2
R R
C
Zin
Fig. 7.18 The negative series lossy SGI based on a single INIC
Vin
1
Iin
INIC
2
R
Zin
R
C
Z in = - R== - sCR2
ð7:22Þ
Example 7.9 Find the input impedance of the structure given in Fig. 7.16. Solution 7.9 After analysis of the circuit in Fig. 7.16, the following input impedance is found as given below. Z in = Z 1 ==ð- Z 2 Þ
ð7:23Þ
If Z1 = R and Z2 = R + 1/(sC) in Fig. 7.16 are chosen, a positive series lossy SGI in Fig. 7.17 is obtained. This series lossy SGI is expressed below [6]. Z in = sCR2 þ R
ð7:24Þ
If Z1 = R + 1/(sC) and Z2 = R in Fig. 7.16 are taken, a negative series lossy SGI in Fig. 7.18 is obtained. This series lossy SGI is expressed as [6]
184
7
Unity Gain Inverting Amplifiers and Negative Impedance Converters C
Vin
1
Iin
INIC
INIC
1
2
(1)
2
(2)
R
R
R
Zin Fig. 7.19 The positive lossless SGI based on two INICs
Vin
Iin
1
INIC
2
1
R
(1)
INIC
2
(2)
R
R
C
Zin
Fig. 7.20 Another positive lossless SGI based on two INICs
Z in = - sCR2 - R
ð7:25Þ
Example 7.10 Find the input impedance of the structure given in Figs. 7.19 and 7.20 [6]. Solution 7.10 Using the results given in the above examples, after analysis of the circuits in Figs. 7.19 and 7.20, the input impedance for both circuits is found below. Z in = sCR2 = sLeq
ð7:26Þ
where Leq = CR2. Example 7.11 Find the input impedance of the circuit given in Fig. 7.21 [7]. Solution 7.11 After analysis of the circuit in Fig. 7.21, the following input impedance is found by Z in ðsÞ =
sCR1 R2 þ R1 - R2 sC ðR2 - R1 Þ þ 4
ð7:27Þ
If R1 = R2 = R is taken, the input impedance of the topology turns to Z in ðsÞ = Here, Leq = CR2/4.
sCR2 = sLeq 4
ð7:28Þ
7.3
NICs
185
Fig. 7.21 A positive lossless SGI based on one INIC and one VNIC
Iin
Vin
Zin
2
INIC
1
R2
R1
1
VNIC 2
C
Vtest
Vtest V1
1
I1
Z1
INIC
I1
2
(1)
Z2
V2
1
I2
INIC
2
(2)
V2
I2
Fig. 7.22 The floating circuit based on two INICs
Example 7.12 Find the admittance matrix equation for the circuit exhibited in Fig. 7.22. Solution 7.12 The following equations can be written for the circuit in Fig. 7.22 to obtain the admittance matrix equation: I1 =
V 1 - V test Z1
ð7:29aÞ
I1 =
V 2 - V test Z2
ð7:29bÞ ð7:29cÞ
I2 = - I1
From above equations, the following admittance matrix equation is found as I1 I2
=
1 Z1 - Z2
1
-1
V1
-1
1
V2
ð7:30Þ
186
7
Unity Gain Inverting Amplifiers and Negative Impedance Converters
Fig. 7.23 Another floating circuit based on two INICs
V1
Ia V1
1
I1
INIC
2
(1)
Ib
Ia Z2
Z1
V2
1
I2
INIC
Fig. 7.24 A Wien oscillator based on one INIC
2
(2)
Ia
1
INIC
R1
V2
Vout
2
C2
R2
C1
Example 7.13 Find the admittance matrix equation for another topology in Fig. 7.23. Solution 7.13 The following equations can be written for the structure in Fig. 7.23 to obtain the admittance matrix equation: I1 = Ia þ Ib
ð7:31aÞ
I 2 = - ðI a þ I b Þ
ð7:31bÞ
Ia =
V2 - V1 Z2
ð7:31cÞ
Ib =
V1 - V2 Z1
ð7:31dÞ
From above equations, the following admittance matrix equation is evaluated as I1 I2
=
1 Z 1 ==ð- Z 2 Þ
1
-1
V1
-1
1
V2
ð7:32Þ
7.3
NICs
187
Fig. 7.25 A second-order VM universal filter based on one INIC and one VF
V1
V2
C1
Vout
Y VF X (2)
R1 R2
C2
2
INIC 1
(1)
Vtest R3
V3
Example 7.14 Find the characteristic equation (D(s)), osillation condition (OC), and osillation frequency (OF) of the Wien oscillator in Fig. 7.24 [8]. Solution 7.14 Analysis of the circuit in Fig. 7.24 is achieved as V out 1 = V out sC 2 þ R2 R1 þ sC1 1
ð7:33Þ
From above equation, D(s) is calculated by DðsÞ = s2 C 1 C 2 R1 R2 þ sðC 1 R1 þ C2 R2 - C 1 R2 Þ þ 1 = 0
ð7:34Þ
Therefore, OC and OF are, respectively, found as follows: C1 R2 ≥ C 1 R1 þ C2 R2 f0 =
1 2π
1 C1 C2 R1 R2
ð7:35aÞ ð7:35bÞ
Note VNIC is sometimes used instead of INIC or vice versa, because INIC changes the direction of current, while VNIC changes the polarity of the voltage. Example 7.15 Find the output voltage (Vout), resonance frequency ( f0), and quality factor (Q) of the universal filter in Fig. 7.25 [9].
188
7
Unity Gain Inverting Amplifiers and Negative Impedance Converters
Solution 7.15 Analysis of the circuit in Fig. 7.25 is carried out as in the following: ðV 1 - V out ÞsC 1 þ
V 2 - V out V - V test = out R1 R2
ð7:36aÞ
V test - V out V - V3 = test R2 R3
ð7:36bÞ
ðV out - V test ÞsC2 þ
From above two equations, if R2 = R3 = R are taken, output response, f0, and Q of the universal filter are, respectively, computed as V out =
s2 C1 C2 R1 R2 V 1 þ sC 2 R2 V 2 þ R1 V 3 s2 C 1 C 2 R1 R2 þ sC 2 R2 þ R1 f0 =
1 1 × p 2π R C 1 C 2
Q=
R1 × R
C1 C2
ð7:37aÞ ð7:37bÞ ð7:37cÞ
One sees from equations given in (7.37) that all the second-order VM filter responses can be easily obtained with appropriate choice of input voltage(s). Furthermore, Q of this filter can be changed by varying R1 without disturbing the resonance frequency f0.
References 1. A. Toker, S. Ozoguz, Tunable all pass filter for low voltage operation. Electron. Lett. 39(2), 175–176 (2003) 2. E. Yuce, S. Minaei, A novel phase shifter using two NMOS transistors and passive elements. Analog Integr. Circuit. Signal Process. (ALOG) 62, 77–81 (2010) 3. E. Yuce, S. Minaei, N. Herencsar, J. Koton, Realization of first-order current-mode filters with low number of MOS transistors. J. Circuit. Syst. Comput. (JCSC) 22(1), 14 (2013) 4. A.S. Sedra, K.C. Smith, A second-generation current conveyor and its applications. IEEE Trans. Circuit Theory 17(1), 132–134 (1970) 5. O. Cicekoglu, H. Kuntman, S. Berk, All-pass filters using a single current conveyor. Int. J. Electron. 86(8), 947–955 (1999) 6. T.S. Rathore, B.M. Singhi, A family of inductance simulation. JIE PT ET-2 61, 58–59 (1980) 7. E. Yuce, H. Alpaslan, S. Minaei, U.E. Ayten, A new simulated grounded inductor based on two NICs, two resistors and a grounded capacitor. Circuit. Syst. Signal Process. (CSSP) 40(12), 5847–5863 (2021) 8. S. Celma, P.A. Martinez, A. Carlosena, Approach to the synthesis of canonic RC-active oscillators using CCII. IEEE Proc. Circuits Devices Syst. 141(6), 493–497 (1994) 9. E. Yuce, S. Tez, A novel voltage-mode universal filter composed of two terminal active devices. Int. J. Electron. Commun. (AEU) 86, 202–209 (2018)
Chapter 8
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
8.1
Introduction
Current conveyors (CCs) have the property of higher linearity, wider bandwidth, larger dynamic range, etc. when compared to operational amplifiers [1–5]. Three generation CCs are available in the literature, first-generation CC (CCI) [6], secondgeneration CC (CCII) [7], and third-generation CC (CCIII) [8]. Other types of CCs such as subtractor connected CCI (S-CCI), current controlled CCII (CCCII), inverting CCII (ICCII), differential CC (DCCII), dual X CCII (DX-CCII), differential voltage CC (DVCC), differential difference CC (DDCC), fully differential CCII (FDCCII), current differencing CC (CDCC), extra X CCCII (EX-CCCII), etc. are also available in the literature.
8.2
CCI
Symbol of the dual-output CCI (DO-CCI) is shown in Fig. 8.1. If one of the Z- or Z + terminal of this DO-CCI is removed, plus-type CCI (CCI+) and minus-type CCI (CCI-) are, respectively, obtained. This DO-CCI is expressed in the matrix equation (8.1). VX IY I Zþ IZ -
=
1 0
0 1
VY
0
1
IX
0
-1
© The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2024 E. Yuce, S. Minaei, Passive and Active Circuits by Example, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6_8
ð8:1Þ
189
190
8
Fig. 8.1 Symbol of the DO-CCI
VY
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
VX
Z+
Y
IY
DO-CCI X
IX
VZ+
IZ+
Z-
VZ-
IZ-
R/2
I1 C
Vin
Iin
R
Vtest
CCI I1
Vtest
Y Z+
X
I1
R
Zin Fig. 8.2 CCI+ based SGI
One of the most important applications of the CCs is found in realization of the simulated inductors (SIs) that can be lossy or lossless. SIs can be divided into two groups, simulated grounded inductor (SGI) and simulated floating inductor (SFI). Example 8.1 Find the input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 8.2 [9]. Solution 8.1 Its analysis is carried out by using the following four equations: I in =
V in - V test þ ðV in - V test ÞsC þ I 1 R V V in - V test = test þ I 1 R R 2V test ðV in - V test ÞsC = þ I1 R V Z in = in I in
ð8:2aÞ ð8:2bÞ ð8:2cÞ ð8:2dÞ
From equations indicated in (8.2), input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 8.2 is evaluated as Z in =
V in 1 = sCR2 3 I in
ð8:3Þ
8.2
CCI
191
R
I1
Vin
Iin
CCI I1
Zin
Vtest
Y
Z-
X
Y
I1
(1)
VF
X
(2)
C
R
Fig. 8.3 CCI- and VF-based SGI
Example 8.2 Find the input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 8.3 [10]. This SGI consists of one CCI and one voltage follower (VF). Solution 8.2 Its analysis is accomplished by using the following four equations: V in - V test þ I1 R V I 1 = - in R
ð8:4bÞ
I 1 = V test sC
ð8:4cÞ
I in =
Z in =
V in I in
ð8:4aÞ
ð8:4dÞ
From equations indicated in (8.4), input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 8.3 is evaluated as Z in =
V in = sCR2 I in
ð8:5Þ
Example 8.3 Find the input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 8.4 [10]. This SGI uses one CCI and one unity gain-inverting amplifier (UGIA). Solution 8.3 Its analysis is accomplished by using the following four equations: I in =
V in - ð- V test Þ þ I1 R V I 1 = - in R
ð8:6aÞ ð8:6bÞ
192
8
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
R
I1
Vin
Iin
Vtest
Y
CCI I1
Zin
X
Z+
Y
I1
(1)
-1
X
(2)
C
R
Fig. 8.4 CCI+ and UGIA-based SGI
R1
I1
Vo1
Vo2
Y
CCI C1
I1
X
Z-
(1)
I1
Y
VF
X
Vo2
(2)
C2
R2
Fig. 8.5 CCI- and VF-based QO
I 1 = - V test sC Z in =
V in I in
ð8:6cÞ ð8:6dÞ
From equations indicated in (8.6), input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 8.4 is calculated as Z in =
V in = sCR2 I in
ð8:7Þ
Example 8.4 Find the characteristic equation (D(s)), oscillation condition (OC), and oscillation frequency (OF) of the quadrature oscillator (QO) demonstrated in Fig. 8.5 [10].
8.3
CCII
193 R1
I1
Vo1
-Vo2
Y
CCI C1
I1
X
(1)
Z+
Y
I1
-1
Vo2
X
(2)
C2
R2
Fig. 8.6 CCI+ and UGIA-based QO
Solution 8.4 Its analysis is carried out by using the following three equations: V o2 - V o1 = V o1 sC 1 þ I 1 R1
ð8:8aÞ
V o1 R2
ð8:8bÞ
I 1 = V o2 sC 2
ð8:8cÞ
I1 = -
From equations indicated in (8.8), D(s) of the QO in Fig. 8.5 is calculated as DðsÞ = s2 C 1 C 2 R1 R2 þ sC 2 ðR2 - R1 Þ þ 1 = 0
ð8:9Þ
From equation denoted in (8.9), OC and OF are, respectively, found as follows: R1 ≥ R2 f0 =
1 1 ×p 2π C1 C2 R1 R2
ð8:10aÞ ð8:10bÞ
If the analysis of the QO in Fig. 8.6 is achieved [10], the same D(s) value evaluated for the circuit in Fig. 8.5 is found.
8.3
CCII
Symbol of the dual-output CCII (DO-CCII) is exhibited in Fig. 8.7. If one of the Zor Z+ terminal of this DO-CCII is removed, plus-type CCII (CCII+) and minus-type CCII (CCII-) are, respectively, obtained. This DO-CCII is defined in the matrix equation (8.11).
194
8
VY
Fig. 8.7 Symbol of the DO-CCII
Y
IY
VX
Fig. 8.8 INIC design based on the CCII
Current Conveyors and Their Applications Z+
DO-CCII Z-
X
IX
IZ-
VZ+ VZ-
Z+
V1
X
I1
CCII
VY
I2
Y
Fig. 8.9 VF design based on the CCII
IY
Y
CCII
X
Z-
Z+
Fig. 8.10 CF design based on the CCII
Z+
VX
VX IY I Zþ IZ -
8.3.1
IZ+
=
IX
1 0
0 0
0 0
1 -1
X
CCII Y
Z-
VY IX
IX
IZ+ IZ-
V2
VX
VZ+ VZ-
ð8:11Þ
Realizations of the Other Active Devices Based on the CCII
Example 8.5 Implement the current negative impedance converter (INIC), VF, and current follower (CF) by utilizing the CCII. Solution 8.5 The INIC, VF, and CF implementations based on the CCII are, respectively, demonstrated in Figs. 8.8, 8.9, and 8.10.
8.3
CCII
8.3.2
195
Realizations of the Instrumentation Amplifier Based on the CCII
Example 8.6 Find the output voltage of the instrumentation amplifier (IA) in Fig. 8.11 [11]. Solution 8.6 Analysis of the IA in Fig. 8.11 is carried out by V out =
R2 ðV - V 1 Þ = A v ðV 2 - V 1 Þ R1 2
ð8:12Þ
Here, Av = R2/R1.
8.3.3
Realizations of the Simulated Inductors Based on the CCII
Example 8.7 Find the input impedance of the SGI designs in Figs. 8.12 [12] and 8.13 [13]. Solution 8.7 Analysis of the SGIs in Fig. 8.12 and 8.13 is achieved by the following two equations: I in =
V test R1
ð8:13aÞ
V in V = V test sC ) V test = in R2 sCR2
ð8:13bÞ
If Vtest in Eq. (8.13b) is replaced into Eq. (8.13a), the following input current is obtained as
Fig. 8.11 IA realization based on the CCII
V2
Y
(1)
CCII
Vout
Z+
X
R2 R1 V1
Y
X
CCII (2)
Z+
196
8
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
Fig. 8.12 The SGI realization based on the CCII
X Z-
(1)
Vin
R1
CCII Y
Vtest
Iin
C
Z+ Y
Zin
Fig. 8.13 Another SGI implementation based on the CCII
CCII (2)
Vin
X
X
Iin
R2
(1)
CCII Y
Z-
Zin
Vtest
Y
(2)
Z+
CCII X
R1
R2 C
V in
I in =
V test V in = sCR2 = R1 R1 sCR1 R2
ð8:14Þ
From above equation, input impedance of the SGIs in Figs. 8.12 and 8.13 is found as Z in =
V in = sCR1 R2 = sLeq I in
ð8:15Þ
where Leq = CR1R2. Example 8.8 Find the admittance matrix equation of the SFI shown in Fig. 8.14 [14]. Solution 8.8 Analysis of the SFI in Fig. 8.14 is accomplished by the following three equations:
8.3
CCII
197 X
V1
I1
Z+
(1)
X
R1
CCII
CCII
Y
Y
Vtest C
CCII (3)
I2
V2
Z+
Z+
Y
Z+
(2)
X
CCII X
R2
Y
(4)
Fig. 8.14 The SFI implementation based on the CCII
I2 = - I1
ð8:16aÞ
V test R1
ð8:16bÞ
I1 = V test sC =
V1 - V2 V - V2 ) V test = 1 R2 sCR2
ð8:16cÞ
If Vtest in Eq. (8.16c) is replaced into equation denoted in (8.16b), the currents I1 and I2 are, respectively, obtained as follows: I1 =
V1 - V2 sCR1 R2
I2 = -
ð8:17aÞ
V1 - V2 sCR1 R2
ð8:17bÞ
Hence, the SFI of Fig. 8.14 is expressed by the following matrix equation: I1 1 = s C R I2 1 R2
1 -1
-1 1
V1 1 = s L V2 eq
1 -1
-1 1
V1 V2
ð8:18Þ
Here, Leq = CR1R2. Example 8.9 Find the admittance matrix equation of the SFI in Fig. 8.15 [15]. Solution 8.9 Analysis of the SFI in Fig. 8.15 is accomplished by the following three equations: I2 = - I1 I1 = -
V test R2
ð8:19aÞ ð8:19bÞ
198
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
8
R2
V1
I1
X
R1
X
Z-
Vtest
CCII (1)
Y
Z+
Z+
CCII Y
(2)
Z-
C
V2
I2
Fig. 8.15 The SFI based on the CCII
R1
Z+
(1)
C1
Y
Vo2
Z-
CCII
Vo1
X
C2
(2)
Z+
CCII Y
Z-
Io1 Io2
X
R2
Fig. 8.16 The QO based on the CCII
V test sC = -
V1 - V2 V - V2 ) V test = - 1 R1 sCR1
ð8:19cÞ
If Vtest in Eq. (8.19c) is replaced into equation denoted in (8.19b), the same currents I1 and I2 are obtained as given for the SFI in Fig. 8.14.
8.3
CCII
8.3.4
199
Realizations of the QOs Based on the CCII
Example 8.10 Find D(s), OC, and OF of the QO in Fig. 8.16 [16]. Solution 8.10 Analysis of the QO in Fig. 8.16 is accomplished by the following two equations: V o1 = - V o2 sC 2 ) V o1 = - V o2 sC 2 R2 R2 V V R V o2 - V o1 = V o1 sC 1 - o1 ) V o2 - V o1 = V o1 sC 1 R1 - o1 1 R1 R2 R2
ð8:20aÞ ð8:20bÞ
If Vo1 in Eq. (8.20a) is replaced into equation denoted in (8.20b), the following equation is obtained by V o2 þ V o2 sC 2 R2 = - V o2 s2 C 1 C 2 R1 R2 þ V o2 sC 2 R1
ð8:21Þ
Rearrangement of equation given in (8.21), the following equation is obtained as V o2 s2 C1 C2 R1 R2 þ sC 2 R2 - sC 2 R1 þ 1 = 0
ð8:22Þ
From above equation, D(s), OC, and OF are, respectively, found as DðsÞ = s2 C 1 C 2 R1 R2 þ sC 2 ðR2 - R1 Þ þ 1 = 0
ð8:23aÞ
R1 ≥ R2
ð8:23bÞ
f0 =
1 1 ×p 2π C1 C2 R1 R2
ð8:23cÞ
The output voltage, Vo1, is expressed in terms of Vo2 as V o1 = - jωC2 R2 V o2
ð8:24Þ
The currents of the QO, Io1 and Io2, are also defined as I o1 = - I o2 =
V o2 - V o1 R1
ð8:25Þ
Example 8.11 Find the D(s), OC, and OF of the QO in Fig. 8.17 [17]. Solution 8.11 Analysis of the QO in Fig. 8.17 is achieved by the following two equations:
200
8
Fig. 8.17 The QO based on the CCII
C1
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
R2
R1
Vo1
X
Y
R3
C2 Z+
CCII (1)
Y
Vo2
X
CCII (2)
Z+
R4 Y
X
CCII Z+
(3)
V o1 = V o2 sC 2 R2
ð8:26aÞ
V V o1 V o2 = V o1 sC 1 þ o1 R4 R3 R1
ð8:26bÞ
From above equations, D(s), OC, and OF are, respectively, found as follows: DðsÞ = s2 C1 C2 R2 R3 þ sC 2 R2 R3
1 1 R1 R4
þ 1=0
R1 ≥ R4 f0 =
8.3.5
1 1 ×p 2π C1 C2 R2 R3
ð8:27aÞ ð8:27bÞ ð8:27cÞ
Realizations of the CCII- Based on the CCII+s
Example 8.12 Implement the CCII- by using the CCII+s. Solution 8.12 Implementation of the CCII- by using two CCII+s is depicted in Fig. 8.18.
8.4
CCIII
VX VY
201
IX
X
IY
(1)
CCII
(2) Z+
CCII
X
Y
Z+
VZ-
IZ-
Y
Fig. 8.18 Realization of the CCII- by utilizing two CCII+s Fig. 8.19 Symbol of the DO-CCIII
VY
Y
IY
VX
Z+
CCIII Z-
X
IX
VZ+
IZ+
VZ-
IZC
Fig. 8.20 Series RL circuit based on the CCIII+ I1
Vin
Iin
Y
CCIII I1
Zin
X
Vtest Z+
I1
R2 R1
8.4
CCIII
Symbol of the dual-output CCIII (DO-CCIII) is demonstrated in Fig. 8.19. If one of the Z- or Z+ terminal of this DO-CCIII is removed, plus-type CCIII (CCIII+) and minus-type CCIII (CCIII-) are, respectively, obtained. This DO-CCIII is defined in the matrix equation (8.28). VX IY I Zþ IZ -
=
1
0
0 0
-1 1
0
-1
VY IX
ð8:28Þ
Example 8.13 Find the input impedance of the series lossy inductor in Fig. 8.20 [18].
202
8
Current Conveyors and Their Applications C
Fig. 8.21 Parallel RL circuit based on the CCIII+ I1
Vin
Iin
Vtest
X
CCIII I1
Y
Zin
Z+
I1
R2 R1
Solution 8.13 The input impedance of the series lossy inductor in Fig. 8.20 is computed with the following four equations: Z in =
V in I in
ð8:29aÞ
I in = - I 1 þ ðV in - V test ÞsC I1 = -
V in V test - V in þ R1 R2
I 1 = ðV in - V test ÞsC þ
V in - V test R2
ð8:29bÞ ð8:29cÞ ð8:29dÞ
From above equations, the input impedance of the series lossy inductor in Fig. 8.20 is evaluated as Z in =
V in = sCR1 R2 þ 2R1 = sLeq þ Req I in
ð8:30Þ
Here, Leq = CR1R2 and Req = 2R1. Example 8.14 Find the input admittance of the parallel lossy inductor in Fig. 8.21 [18]. Solution 8.14 The input admittance of the parallel lossy inductor in Fig. 8.20 is calculated with the following four equations: Y in =
I in V in
I in = I 1 þ ðV in - V test ÞsC
ð8:31aÞ ð8:31bÞ
8.5
CCCII
203
I1 =
V in V in - V test þ R1 R2
I 1 = ðV in - V test ÞsC þ
ð8:31cÞ
V in - V test R2
ð8:31dÞ
From above equations, the input admittance of the parallel lossy inductor in Fig. 8.21 is found below. Y in =
I in 1 2 1 1 = þ = þ V in sCR1 R2 R1 sLeq Req
ð8:32Þ
where Leq = CR1R2 and Req = R1/2.
8.5
CCCII
Symbol of the dual-output CCCII (DO-CCCII) is exhibited in Fig. 8.22. If one of the Z- or Z+ terminal of this DO-CCCII is removed, plus-type CCCII (CCCII+) and minus-type CCCII (CCCII-) are respectively obtained. This DO-CCCII is defined in the matrix equation (8.33), where RX = VT/(2Io) and VT ffi 26 mV at room temperature [19]. VX IY
=
IZ I Zþ
1 0
RX 0
0 -1 0 1
VY
ð8:33Þ
IX
Example 8.15 Find the input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 8.23 [12]. This SGI is obtained by removing both resistors of one in Fig. 8.12 [12]. Solution 8.15 According to the solution given in Example 8.7 (for circuit of Fig. 8.12), the input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 8.23 is evaluated as
Fig. 8.22 Symbol of the DO-CCCII
VY VX
Y
IY RX
IX
Z+
DO-CCCII Z-
X
Io
IZ+ IZ-
VZ+ VZ-
204
8
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
Fig. 8.23 The SGI based on the CCCII
X
CCCII
Z-
(1)
Vin
Y
Io1
Iin
C Z+
CCCII
Y
Zin
(2)
X
Io2
Fig. 8.24 Symbol of the DO-ICCII
VY VX
Z in =
IY IX
Y
Z+
DO-ICCII X
V in = sCRX1 RX2 = sLeq I in
Z-
IZ+
IZ-
VZ+ VZ-
ð8:34Þ
Here, Leq = CRX1RX2.
8.6
ICCII
Symbol of the dual-output ICCII (DO-ICCII) is demonstrated in Fig. 8.24. If one of the Z- or Z+ terminal of this DO-ICCII is removed, plus-type ICCII (ICCII+) and minus-type ICCII (ICCII-) are respectively obtained. This DO-ICCII is defined in the matrix equation (8.35). VX IY I Zþ IZ -
=
-1 0
0 0
0 0
1 -1
VY IX
ð8:35Þ
Example 8.16 Find the transfer functions (TFs) of the first-order current-mode (CM) universal filter in Fig. 8.25 [20].
8.6
ICCII
205
C
Fig. 8.25 The DO-ICCIIbased first-order CM universal filter
Iin
Vtest Z-
Y
ILP
ICCII
R X
Z+
IAP
Solution 8.16 The input current of the universal filter of Fig. 8.25 is expressed as I in =
2V test þ V test × sC R
ð8:36Þ
From above equation, Vtest is found as follows: V test =
RI in 2 þ sCR
ð8:37Þ
The first-order low-pass filter (LPF) response by using the equation denoted in (8.37) is evaluated by I LP =
2V test 2I in = R 2 þ sCR
ð8:38Þ
From above equation, TF of the LPF is computed as I LP 1 = I in 1 þ 0:5sCR
ð8:39Þ
TF of the first-order CM all-pass filter (APF) is calculated as follows: I AP 1 - 0:5sCR =I in 1 þ 0:5sCR
ð8:40Þ
From equations indicated in (8.39) and (8.40), the angular pole frequency is calculated as ω0 = 1/(0.5RC). The phase angle is also evaluated as ∠ðI AP =I in Þ = 180o - 2 tan - 1 ð0:5ωCRÞ
ð8:41Þ
By interconnection of low-pass and all-pass currents in Fig. 8.25, a first-order highpass current is easily obtained. Thus, the TF of the high-pass filter is found as
206
8
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
0:5sCR I HP = 1 þ 0:5sCR I in
8.7
ð8:42Þ
DCCII
Symbol of the dual-output DCCII (DO-DCCII) is demonstrated in Fig. 8.26. If one of the Z- or Z+ terminal of this DO-DCCII is removed, plus-type DCCII (DCCII+) and minus-type DCCII (DCCII-) are respectively obtained. This DO-DCCII is defined in the matrix equation (8.43). V XP
1
0
0
V XN IY
1 = 0
0 0
0 0
VY I XP
I Zþ IZ -
0 0
1 -1
-1 1
I XN
ð8:43Þ
Example 8.17 Find the input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 8.27 [21]. Solution 8.17 The input impedance of the SGI of Fig. 8.27 is evaluated by using the following seven equations: Z in =
VY VXN VXP
IY IXN
IXP
ð8:44aÞ
I Zþ = I XP - I XN
ð8:44bÞ
I Z - = I XN - I XP
ð8:44cÞ
V Y sC = - I Zþ
ð8:44dÞ
Y XN
V in I in
Z+
DO-DCCII
XP
Fig. 8.26 The symbol of the DO-DCCII
Z-
IZ+
IZ-
VZ+
VZ-
8.7
DCCII
207
Fig. 8.27 The DO-DCCIIbased SGI C
Y
IXN R2
XN
IXP
Z+
DO-DCCII Z-
XP
IZ+ IZ-
Iin
Vin
R1
Zin VY VXN
VXP
IY IXN IXP
Y
XN
ZP+
DXCCII ZN-
XP
IZP+
IZN-
VZP+
VZN-
Fig. 8.28 The symbol of the DXCCII
I XN = I in = I Z - þ I XP =
VY R2
V in - V Y R1
V in - V Y R1
ð8:44eÞ ð8:44fÞ ð8:44gÞ
From above equations, input impedance is calculated as Z in =
V in = sCR1 R2 þ R1 - R2 = sLeq þ Req I in
ð8:45Þ
Here, Leq = CR1R2 and Req = R1 - R2. If R1 = R2 in Fig. 8.27 is chosen, a positive lossless SGI is obtained.
208
8.8
8
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
DXCCII
Symbol of the DXCCII is exhibited in Fig. 8.28. This DXCCII is defined in the matrix equation (8.46). V XP
1
0
0
V XN IY
-1 0
0 0
0 0
VY I XP
I ZPþ
0
1
0
I XN
I ZN -
0
0
-1
=
ð8:46Þ
Example 8.18 Find the input admittance of the SGI in Fig. 8.29 [22]. Solution 8.18 The input admittance of the SGI of Fig. 8.29 is evaluated by using the following three equations: Y in =
I in V in
ð8:47aÞ
I in = ðV in - V test ÞsC -
V test R2
ð8:47bÞ
V in = ðV test - V in ÞsC R1
ð8:47cÞ
From above equations, input admittance is computed as follows:
Fig. 8.29 The DXCCIIbased SGI R1
Vin
Iin
XP
XN
DXCCII ZN-
ZP+
Zin
Vtest R2
Y
C
8.9
DVCC
209
Y in =
I in 1 1 1 1 1 = þ = þ V in sCR1 R2 R1 R2 sLeq Req
ð8:48Þ
where Leq = CR1R2 and 1/Req = 1/R1- 1/R2. If R1 = R2 in Fig. 8.27 is chosen, a positive lossless SGI is obtained.
8.9
DVCC
Symbol of the dual-output DVCC (DO-DVCC) is demonstrated in Fig. 8.30. If one of the Z- or Z+ terminal of this DO-DVCC is removed, plus-type DVCC (DVCC+) and minus-type DVCC (DVCC-) are, respectively, obtained. This DO-DVCC is defined in the matrix equation (8.49). 1
-1
0
I Y1
0
0
0
V Y1
I Y2 I Zþ
= 0 0
0 0
0 1
V Y2 IX
IZ -
0
0
-1
VX
Fig. 8.30 The symbol of the DO-DVCC
VY1 VY2
IY1 IY2
ð8:49Þ
Z+
Y1
IZ+
DO-DVCC Y2
X
Z-
IZ-
VZ+ VZ-
IX VX Fig. 8.31 The DVCC+ based IA
V2
Y1
DVCC V1
Y2
Vout
Z+
X
R2
R1
210
8
Current Conveyors and Their Applications X
Z+
Y2
Vin
DVCC (1)
Y1
Vtest
Iin
Y2
C
Z+
Y1
Zin
R1
DVCC (2)
X
R2
Fig. 8.32 The DVCC+ based SGI Fig. 8.33 The DVCC+ based SGI
Vin
X
Iin
(1)
Y2
DVCC Y1
Z+
Zin Vtest
Y2
(2)
Z+
DVCC Y1
X
R1
R2 C
Example 8.19 Find the output voltage of the IA in Fig. 8.31 [23]. Solution 8.19 The output voltage of the IA in Fig. 8.31 is found by V out =
R2 ðV - V 1 Þ R1 2
ð8:50Þ
Example 8.20 Find the input impedances of the SGIs in Fig. 8.32 [24] and Fig. 8.33 [25]. Solution 8.20 The input impedances of the SGIs in Figs. 8.32 and 8.33 are found by using the following three equations:
8.9
DVCC
211
R1
V1
X
Y2
DVCC
(1)
Z+
Z-
Y1
I1
I2
V2
C
Vtest Z-
Y1
Z+
DVCC
(2)
Y2
X
R2
Fig. 8.34 The DVCC-based SFI
Z in = I in = V test sC = -
V in I in
ð8:51aÞ
V test R1
ð8:51bÞ
V in V ) V test = - in R2 sCR2
ð8:51cÞ
From above equations, the input impedance is evaluated as below. Z in =
V in = sCR1 R2 = sLeq I in
ð8:52Þ
Here, Leq = CR1R2. Example 8.21 Find the admittance matrix equation for the SFI in Fig. 8.34 [26]. Solution 8.21 The admittance matrix equation for the SFI in Fig. 8.34 is obtained by using the following three equations: I2 = - I1
ð8:53aÞ
212
8
Fig. 8.35 The DVCCbased non-inverting firstorder VM APF
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
Vin
X
R
Vout
Y2
DVCC Z-
Y1
Vtest C
I1 = V test sC =
V test R2
ð8:53bÞ
V1 - V2 V - V2 ) V test = 1 R1 sCR1
ð8:53cÞ
From above equations, the admittance matrix equation for the SFI in Fig. 8.34 is expressed as I1 I2
=
1 s C R1 R2
1
-1
V1
-1
1
V2
ð8:54Þ
Example 8.22 Find the TF of the APF depicted in Fig. 8.35 [27]. Solution 8.22 The TF of the APF in 8.35 is found by using the following two equations: V in - V out = V test sC R
ð8:55aÞ
V out = V test - V in
ð8:55bÞ
From above equations, the TF of the non-inverting first-order VM APF is computed as 1 - sCR V out = 1 þ sCR V in
ð8:56Þ
Example 8.23 Find the output voltage of the VM full-wave rectifier (FWR) in Fig. 8.36 [28]. Solution 8.23 Analysis of the FWR of Fig. 8.36 is achieved as in the following: If vin(t) ≥ 0 is taken, D1 is ON and D2 is OFF. Thus, the following output voltage is obtained:
8.10
DDCC
213 Y2
vin(t)
Y1
Y1
DVCC Z+ Y2
X
D2
(2)
DVCC X
D1
(1)
vout(t)
Z+
R2
R1
Fig. 8.36 The DVCC-based VM FWR
vout ðt Þ =
R2 - 1 vin ðt Þ R1
ð8:57Þ
If R2 = 2R1 for the equation denoted in (8.57) is chosen, the output voltage simplifies as vout ðt Þ = vin ðt Þ
ð8:58Þ
If vin(t) < 0 is selected, D1 is OFF and D2 is ON. Hence, the output voltage becomes as follows: vout ðt Þ = - vin ðt Þ
ð8:59Þ
From combination of the equations in (8.58) and (8.59), the following output voltage is obtained: vout ðt Þ = jvin ðt Þj
ð8:60Þ
8.10 DDCC Symbol of the dual-output DDCC (DO-DDCC) is given in Fig. 8.37. If one of the Z- or Z+ terminal of this DO-DDCC is removed, plus-type DDCC (DVCC+) and minus-type DDCC (DDCC-) are, respectively, obtained. This DO-DDCC is defined in the matrix equation (8.61).
214
8
Fig. 8.37 The symbol of the DO-DDCC
VY1
Y1
IY1
VY2
Y2
IY2
VY3
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
Z+
DO-DDCC
Y3
IY3
IZ+
X
Z-
IZ-
VZ+
VZ-
IX
VX Y2
Vin
R
Y3
DDCC
Y1
Z+
X
Vout
Vtest C
Fig. 8.38 The DDCC-based first-order VM APF
-1 1 0 0
VX I Y1
1 0
0 0
I Y2 I Y3
0 = 0
0 0
V Y1
0 0
0 0
V Y2 V Y3
I Zþ
0
0
0
1
IX
IZ -
0
0
0
-1
ð8:61Þ
Example 8.24 Find the TF of the APF depicted in Fig. 8.38 [29]. Solution 8.24 The TF of the APF in Fig. 8.38 is found by using the following two equations: V test =
V in 1 þ sCR
V out = 2V test - V in
ð8:62aÞ ð8:62bÞ
From above equations, the TF of the APF in Fig. 8.38 is evaluated as V out 1 - sCR = V in 1 þ sCR
ð8:63Þ
8.10
DDCC
215
(2)
Y2
DDCC Vin
Y1
(1)
DDCC
Y3
Z+
Y1
Y2
Vtest
X
Vout
X
Y3
Z+
C
R
Fig. 8.39 The DDCC-based first-order VM APF
Y1
(2)
DDCC Vin
Y1 Y3
(1)
DDCC
Y2
Z+
Vout
Y3
Vtest
Y2
X
Z+
X
C
R
Fig. 8.40 The DDCC-based first-order VM APF
Example 8.25 Find the TF of the APF shown in Fig. 8.39 [30]. Solution 8.25 The TF of the APF of Fig. 8.39 is computed by using the following two equations: 2V in 1 þ sCR
ð8:64aÞ
V out = V test - V in
ð8:64bÞ
V test =
From above equations, the TF of the APF in Fig. 8.39 is found as follows: 1 - sCR V out = 1 þ sCR V in
ð8:65Þ
216
8
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
Example 8.26 Find the TF of the APF shown in Fig. 8.40 [30]. This circuit is found from the one given in Example 8.25 by interchanging the Y1 and Y2 terminals of the second DDCC. Solution 8.26 The TF of the APF of Fig. 8.40 is calculated by using the following two equations: 2V in 1 þ sCR
ð8:66aÞ
V out = V in - V test
ð8:66bÞ
V test =
From above equations, the TF of the APF in Fig. 8.40 is found as follows: 1 - sCR V out =1 þ sCR V in
8.11
ð8:67Þ
FDCCII
The symbol of the FDCCII is demonstrated in Fig. 8.41, while representation of the FDCCII with matrix equation is given in (8.68).
VY1 VY2 VY3 VY4
IY1 IY2 IY3 IY4
Y1
ZA+
Y2
FDCCII
Y3 Y4
XA
IXA
IXB
VXA Fig. 8.41 The symbol of the FDCCII
XB
VXB
ZA-
ZB+ ZB-
IZA+ IZAIZB+ IZB-
VZA+ VZAVZB+ VZB-
8.11
FDCCII
217
Fig. 8.42 The FDCCIIbased SGI
Y1
Vin
ZB-
Iin
Y2
ZA- ZB+
FDCCII
Y3
Y4 ZA+
XA
XB
Zin R1
V XA
1
-1
1
0
0
0
V XB I Y1
-1 0
1 0
0 0
1 0
0 0
0 0
V Y1
I Y2 I Y3
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
V Y2 V Y3
0
0
0
0
0
0
V Y4
I ZAþ I ZA -
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
1 -1
0 0
I XA I XB
I ZBþ I ZB -
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
1 -1
I Y4
=
C
R2
ð8:68Þ
Example 8.27 Find the input impedance of the SGI shown in Fig. 8.42 [31]. Solution 8.27 The input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 8.42 is found by using the following six equations: V in I in
ð8:69aÞ
V Y3 = V in
ð8:69bÞ
V XA = V Y3
ð8:69cÞ
V XB = V Y4
ð8:69dÞ
V XB R2
ð8:69eÞ
Z in =
I in =
218
8
VY1 VY2 VY3
IY1
IY2 IY3
Y1 Y2
Y3
(1)
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
Z+
DO-DDCC Z-
X
IZA+
IZA-
VZA+
VZA-
IXA
VXA Y1 Y2
VY4
IY4
Y3
(2)
Z+
DO-DDCC Z-
X
IZB+
IZB-
VZB+
VZB-
IXB VXB Fig. 8.43 Realization of the FDCCII by utilizing two DO-DDCCs
V V V XA = V Y4 sC ) in = V Y4 sC = V XB sC ) V XB = in R1 R1 sCR1
ð8:69fÞ
From above equations, input impedance is found below. Z in =
V in = sCR1 R2 = sLeq I in
ð8:70Þ
Here, Leq = CR1R2. Example 8.28 Realize the FDCCII by using the DO-DDCCs. Solution 8.28 Implementation of the FDCCII by using two DO-DDCCs is given in Fig. 8.43.
8.12
CDCC
The symbol of the CDCC is exhibited in Fig. 8.44, while representation of the CDCC with matrix equation is given in (8.71).
8.12
CDCC
219
Fig. 8.44 The symbol of the CDCC
VP
VN
W+
P
IP
CDCC N
IN
Z
W-
X
IZ
VW+
IW+
VW-
IW-
IX VX
VZ Fig. 8.45 The CDCCbased topology
Vin
Iin
W+
P
R1
CDCC N
0 0
IZ VX
=
1 0
X
W-
VZ
Zin
VP VN
Z
C
0 0
0 0
0 0
IP
-1 0 0 1
0 0
IN VZ IX
I Wþ
0
0
0
1
IW -
0
0
0
-1
R2
ð8:71Þ
Example 8.29 Find the input admittance of the circuit in Fig. 8.45 [32]. Solution 8.29 The input admittance of the circuit given in Fig. 8.45 is computed by using the following six equations: Y in =
I in V in
IN = 0 I Z = I P ) - V Z sC =
V in V ) V Z = - in R1 sCR1
ð8:72aÞ ð8:72bÞ ð8:72cÞ
220
8
Vin
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
(1)
Iin
Y
VF
X
R1
P
W+
(2)
CDCC N
Z
X
W-
VZ
Zin
C
R2
Fig. 8.46 The CDCC-based SGI
I Wþ = I X =
- VX V =- Z R2 R2
ð8:72dÞ
V in R1
ð8:72eÞ
I in = I Wþ þ I in =
V in V þ in sCR1 R2 R1
ð8:72fÞ
From above equations, input admittance is evaluated as Y in =
I in 1 1 1 1 = þ = þ V in sCR1 R2 R1 sLeq Req
ð8:73Þ
where Leq = CR1R2 and Req = R1. So, the circuit realizes parallel Req and Leq. Example 8.30 Find the input admittance of the circuit in Fig. 8.46 [33]. Solution 8.30 The input admittance of the SGI in Fig. 8.46 is computed by using the following six equations: Y in =
I in V in
IN = 0 I Z = I P ) - V Z sC = I Wþ = I X =
V in V ) V Z = - in R1 sCR1
- VX V =- Z R2 R2
I in = I Wþ
ð8:74aÞ ð8:74bÞ ð8:74cÞ ð8:74dÞ ð8:74eÞ
8.13
EX-CCCII
221
I in =
V in sCR1 R2
ð8:74fÞ
From above equations, input admittance is computed as follows: Y in =
I in 1 1 = = V in sCR1 R2 sLeq
ð8:75Þ
where Leq = CR1R2. So, the circuit realizes pure (lossless) inductance Leq.
8.13
EX-CCCII
The symbol of the EX-CCCII is exhibited in Fig. 8.47, while presentation of the EX-CCCII with matrix equation is given in (8.76). In this active block, RX is a function of external current Io. IY
0
0
0
V X1 V X2
1 1
RX1 0
0 RX2
VY
I Z1þ
= 0
1
0
I X1
I Z1 I Z2þ
0 0
-1 0
0 1
I X2
I Z2 -
0
0
-1
ð8:76Þ
Io Z1+
VY
IY
Y
EX-CCCII X1
IX1 VX1 Fig. 8.47 The symbol of the EX-CCCII
X2
IX2 VX2
Z1Z2+ Z2-
IZ1+ IZ1IZ2+ IZ2-
VZ1+
VZ1VZ2+ VZ2-
222
8
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
Fig. 8.48 The EX-CCCIIbased SGI
Io I2
Vin
Iin
Z1Y
I1
Zin
EX-CCCII
Z2+ X1
Z2-
X2
C
Z1+
Vtest
Example 8.31 Find the input impedance of the SGI shown in Fig. 8.48 [34]. Solution 8.31 The input impedance of the SGI is calculated by using the following five equations: Z in =
V in I in
I in = I 1 þ I 2 I1 =
V test - V in RX2
I 2 = V test sC I2 =
V in RX1
ð8:77aÞ ð8:77bÞ ð8:77cÞ ð8:77dÞ ð8:77eÞ
From above equations and considering IZ2- = -IX2, the input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 8.48 is found by Z in =
V in sCRX1 RX2 = I in 1 þ sC ðRX2 - RX1 Þ
ð8:78Þ
One observes from the equation denoted in (8.78) that the SGI in Fig. 8.48 needs a single active element matching condition, RX1 = RX2, to provide a positive lossless SGI.
References
223
References 1. G. Ferri, N.C. Guerrini, Low Voltage, Low Power CMOS Current Conveyors (Springer, 2003) 2. B. Wilson, Tutorial review trends in current conveyor and current-mode amplifier design. Int. J. Electron. 73(3), 573–583 (1992) 3. C. Toumazou, F.J. Lidgey, D.G. Haigh, Analog IC Design: The Current-Mode Approach (Peter Peregrinus, London, 1993) ISBN: 978-0863412974 4. B. Wilson, Recent developments in current conveyors and current-mode circuits. IEE Proc. -G Circuit. Devices Syst. 137(2), 63–77 (1990) 5. R. Senani, D.R. Bhaskar, A.K. Singh, Current Conveyors: Variants, Applications and Hardware Implementations (Springer, 2014) 6. A. Sedra, K.C. Smith, The current conveyor: A new circuit building block. Proc. IEEE 56(8), 1368–1369 (1968) 7. A.S. Sedra, K.C. Smith, A second-generation current conveyor and its applications. IEEE Trans. Circuit Theory 17(1), 132–134 (1970) 8. A. Fabre, Third-generation current conveyor: A new helpful active element. Electron. Lett. 31(5), 338–339 (1995) 9. E. Arslan, U. Cam, O. Cicekoglu, Novel lossless grounded inductance simulators employing only a single first generation current conveyor. Frequenz 57(9–10), 204–206 (2003) 10. H. Alpaslan, E. Yuce, S. Minaei, A new active device namely S-CCI and its applications: Simulated floating inductor and quadrature oscillators. IEEE Trans. Circuit. Syst. I Regular Papers 69(9), 3554–3564 (2022) 11. C. Toumazou, F.J. Lidgey, P.Y.K. Cheung, Current-mode analogue signal processing circuits-a review of recent developments. In 1989 IEEE International Symposium on Circuits and Systems (ISCAS) (IEEE, 1989), pp. 1572–1575 12. A. Sedra, K. Smith, A second-generation current conveyor and its applications. IEEE Trans. Circuit Theory 17(1), 132–134 (1970) 13. O. Cicekoglu, New current conveyor based active-gyrator implementation. Microelectron. J. 29(8), 525–528 (1998) 14. W. Kiranon, P. Pawarangkoon, Floating inductance simulation based on current conveyors. Electron. Lett. 33(21), 1748–1749 (1997) 15. P.A. Mohan, Grounded capacitor based grounded and floating inductance simulation using current conveyors. Electron. Lett. 34(11), 1037–1038 (1998) 16. E. Yuce, DO-CCII/DO-DVCC based electronically fine tunable quadrature oscillators. J. Circuit. Syst. Comput. 26(02), 1750025 (2017) 17. P.A. Martinez, J. Sabadell, C. Aldea, S. Celma, Variable frequency sinusoidal oscillators based on CCII+. IEEE Trans. Circuit. Syst. I Fundamental Theory Appl. 46(11), 1386–1390 (1999) 18. H.-Y. Wang, C.-T. Lee, Systematic synthesis of RL and CD immittances using single CCIII. Int. J. Electron. 87(3), 293–301 (2000) 19. A. Fabre, O. Saaid, F. Wiest, C. Boucheron, High frequency applications based on a new current controlled conveyor. IEEE Trans. Circuit. Syst. I Fundamental Theory Appl. 43(2), 82–91 (1996) 20. L. Safari, E. Yuce, S. Minaei, A new ICCII based resistor-less current-mode first-order universal filter with electronic tuning capability. Microelectron. J. 67, 101–110 (2017) 21. B. Metin, Canonical inductor simulators with grounded capacitors using DCCII. Int. J. Electron. 99(7), 1027–1035 (2012) 22. I. Myderrizi, S. Minaei, E. Yuce, DXCCII-based grounded inductance simulators and filter applications. Microelectron. J. 42(9), 1074–1081 (2011) 23. T.M. Hassan, S.A. Mahmoud, New CMOS DVCC realization and applications to instrumentation amplifier and active-RC filters. AEU Int. J. Electron. Commun. 64(1), 47–55 (2010) 24. A.R. Hamad, M.A. Ibrahim, Grounded generalized impedance converter based on differential voltage current conveyor (DVCC) and its applications. ZANCO J. Pure Appl. Sci. 29(3), 118–127 (2017)
224
8
Current Conveyors and Their Applications
25. T. Unuk, DVCC+ based grounded simulator suitable for capacitance multiplier and frequency dependent negative resistor. In 33rd International Conference (Radioelektronika, Pardubice, 2023) 26. K. Pal, Modified current conveyors and their applications. Microelectron. J. 20(4), 37–40 (1989) 27. H.-P. Chen, K.-H. Wu, Grounded-capacitor first-order filter using minimum components. IEICE Trans. Fundam. Electron. Commun. Comput. Sci. 89(12), 3730–3731 (2006) 28. M.A. Ibrahim, E. Yuce, S. Minaei, A new DVCC-based fully cascadable voltage-mode fullwave rectifier. J. Comput. Electron. 15, 1440–1449 (2016) 29. A. Toker, S. Ozoguz, Novel all-pass filter section using differential difference amplifier. AEU Int. J. Electron. Commun. 58(2), 153–155 (2004) 30. M. Kumngern, K. Dejhan, High-input and low-output impedance voltage-mode all-pass networks. In Proceedings of the 2009 12th International Symposium on Integrated Circuits (IEEE, 2009), pp. 381–384 31. F. Kacar, New lossless inductance simulators realization using a minimum active and passive components. Microelectron. J. 41(2–3), 109–113 (2010) 32. F. Kacar, H. Kuntman, A. Kuntman, Grounded inductance simulator topologies realization with single current differencing current conveyor. In 2015 European Conference on Circuit Theory and Design (ECCTD) (IEEE, 2015), pp. 1–4 33. S. Tez, O.M. Tez, E. Yuce, Derivation of Lossless Grounded Inductor Simulators Based on Active Circuit Elements (ICAT, Antalya, 2018) 34. D. Agrawal, S. Maheshwari, Electronically tunable grounded immittance simulators using an EX-CCCII. Int. J. Electron. 107(10), 1625–1648 (2020)
Chapter 9
Other Active Devices
9.1
Introduction
In this chapter, other active elements such as current feedback operational amplifier (CFOA), operational transresistance amplifier (OTRA), four-terminal floating nullor (FTFN), operational transconductance amplifier (OTA), voltage differencing inverting buffered amplifier (VDIBA), voltage differencing buffer amplifier (VDBA), current differencing buffered amplifier (CDBA), current amplifier (CA), current follower transconductance amplifier (CFTA), current differencing transconductance amplifier (CDTA), differential voltage current conveyor transconductance amplifier (DVCCTA), and current operational amplifier (COA) are treated. Moreover, implementation of the OTRA, FTFN, and CDBA by using two CFOAs is given.
9.2
CFOA
CFOA is a commercially available active device. In other words, the CFOA can be easily obtained by using one AD844 [1]. The symbol of the CFOA is shown in Fig. 9.1, while the current-voltage relationships among terminals of the CFOA can be expressed in the matrix equation (9.1). Implementation of the CFOA by using one plus-type second-generation current conveyor (CCII+) and one voltage follower (VF) is given in Fig. 9.2.
© The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2024 E. Yuce, S. Minaei, Passive and Active Circuits by Example, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6_9
225
226
9
Fig. 9.1 The symbol of the CFOA
IY
VY
Y
IW
CFOA W
IX
VX
Other Active Devices
Z
X
VW
IZ VZ
VY VX
IY IX
Y
(1)
CCII
(2)
VF
Y
Z+
X
X
VW
IW
IZ VZ
Fig. 9.2 Realization of the CFOA by using one CCII+ and one VF
R1
Fig. 9.3 The CFOA-based series RL
Vin
Iin
Y
CFOA W Z
X
Vtest
R2
Zin
C
IY
0
0
0 0
IX
IZ VX
1 = 0
0 1
0 0 0 0
VY VZ
VW
0
0
1 0
IW
ð9:1Þ
Example 9.1 Find the input impedance of the series RL in Fig. 9.3 [2]. Solution 9.1 The input impedance of the series RL in Fig. 9.3 is obtained by using the following three equations:
9.2
CFOA
227
V in I in
ð9:2aÞ
V in - V test R1
ð9:2bÞ
Z in = I in =
ðV test - V in ÞsC = -
V test R2
ð9:2cÞ
Rearrangement of the equation in (9.2c), Vtest, is found below. V test =
V in sC sC þ R12
ð9:3Þ
If Vtest in Eq. (9.3) is replaced into (9.2b), the input current is evaluated as follows: 1 V in sC þ R2 V in sC V in sC V in 1 1 1 sC þ sC þ sC þ R2 R2 R2 = I in = R1 R1 1 1 V in V in × R2 R2 R2 1 1 sC þ sC þ × R2 R2 R2 = = R1 R1 1 V in V in × V in sCR2 þ 1 sCR2 þ 1 R1 = = = 1 R1 sCR1 R2 þ R1 R1 × R1
ð9:4Þ
From above equation, the input impedance is computed as Z in =
V in = sCR1 R2 þ R1 = sLeq þ Req I in
ð9:5Þ
Here, Leq = CR1R2 and Req = R1. Example 9.2 Find the input impedance of the simulated grounded inductor (SGI) in Fig. 9.4 [3]. Solution 9.2 The input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 9.4 is obtained by using the following three equations:
228
9
Vin
Y
Iin
X
Zin
R2
CFOA W
R1
(1) Z
X
Other Active Devices
Z
CFOA W (2)
Vtest
Y
C
Fig. 9.4 The CFOA-based SGI
Z in =
V in I in
ð9:6aÞ
I in =
V test R2
ð9:6bÞ
V in V = V test sC ) V test = in R1 sCR1
ð9:6cÞ
If Vtest indicated in (9.6c) is replaced into the equation in (9.6b), the following input current is obtained: I in =
V in sCR1
R2
=
V in sCR1 R2
ð9:7Þ
From above equation, the input impedance is calculated as Z in =
V in = sCR1 R2 = sLeq I in
ð9:8Þ
where Leq = CR1R2. Example 9.3 Find the input impedance of the CFOA-based SGI demonstrated in Fig. 9.5 [4]. Also, this SGI has the feature of improved low-frequency performance. Solution 9.3 The input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 9.5 is obtained by using the following three equations: Z in = I in = -
V in I in
ð9:9aÞ
V test R1
ð9:9bÞ
9.2
CFOA
229
X (1) W CFOA Z Y Y
C
(2) CFOA W Z X Iin
Vtest
R3
R1
R2
Vin
Zin
Fig. 9.5 The CFOA-based SGI with the property of improved low-frequency performance
Y
(1)
R
CFOA W
Vin
Iin
Z
X
Vtest C1
X
(2)
CFOA W Y
Z
C2
Zin Fig. 9.6 The CFOA-based grounded FDNR
- V test V in - V test = - V test sC R2 R3
ð9:9cÞ
From above equations, the input impedance is calculated as Z in =
R V in = sCR1 R2 þ R1 2 - 1 I in R3
ð9:10Þ
In equation denoted in (9.10), if R3 = R2 is taken, a positive lossless SGI is obtained. Example 9.4 Find the input impedance of the CFOA-based grounded frequencydependent negative resistor (FDNR) in Fig. 9.6 [5]. Solution 9.4 The input impedance of the FDNR in Fig. 9.6 is obtained by using the following three equations:
230
9
V1
Z
I1
R1
X
Z
CFOA W
W CFOA (1) Y
Y
X
(2)
Other Active Devices
I2
V2
Y
Vtest
Z
CFOA W
C
(3)
X
R2
Fig. 9.7 The CFOA-based positive lossless SFI
Z in =
V in I in
ð9:11aÞ
I in = - V test sC 1
ð9:11bÞ
V test = - V in sC 2 ) V test = - V in sC 2 R R
ð9:11cÞ
From above equations, the input impedance is found as Z in =
1 V in 1 = 2 = I in s C 1 C 2 R s2 D
ð9:12Þ
Here, D = C1C2R. Example 9.5 Find the admittance matrix equation of the CFOA-based simulated floating inductor (SFI) in Fig. 9.7 [6]. Solution 9.5 The admittance matrix equation of the SFI given in Fig. 9.7 is obtained by using the following three equations: I2 = - I1
ð9:13aÞ
V test R1
ð9:13bÞ
I1 =
V1 - V2 V - V2 = V test sC ) V test = 1 R2 sCR2
ð9:13cÞ
From above equations, the following admittance matrix equation is obtained:
9.2
CFOA
231
X (1) W CFOA Z Y
Vo1
Y C1
R3 R1
(2) CFOA W Z X
Vo2
R2
C2
Fig. 9.8 The CFOA-based QO
I1 1 = s C R I2 1 R2
1 -1
-1 1
V1 1 = s L V2 eq
1 -1
-1 1
V1 V2
ð9:14Þ
where Leq = CR1R2. Example 9.6 Find the characteristic eq. (D(s)), oscillation condition (OC), and oscillation frequency (OF) of the CFOA-based quadrature oscillator (QO) in Fig. 9.8 [7]. Solution 9.6 The D(s), OC, and OF of the CFOA-based QO shown in Fig. 9.8 are obtained by using the following two equations: V o1 = V o2 sC 2 ) V o1 = V o2 sC 2 R1 R1 V V R V o2 - V o1 = - V o1 sC 1 - o1 ) V o2 - V o1 = - V o1 sC 1 R2 - o1 2 R2 R3 R3
ð9:15aÞ ð9:15bÞ
From above equations, the D(s), OC, and OF of the CFOA-based QO in Fig. 9.8 are, respectively, evaluated by DðsÞ = s2 C 1 C 2 R1 R2 þ sC 2 R1
R2 -1 þ 1=0 R3
R3 ≥ R2 f0 =
1 1 p 2π C 1 C 2 R1 R2
This QO can be controlled orthogonally by changing value of R1.
ð9:16aÞ ð9:16bÞ ð9:16cÞ
232
9.3
9
Other Active Devices
OTRA
The symbol of the OTRA is depicted in Fig. 9.9, while the OTRA can be expressed by the following matrix equation: VP =
VN VO
0
0
0
IP
0 Rm
0 - Rm
0 0
IN IO
ð9:17Þ
Here, Rm is ideally infinity. Example 9.7 Find the input impedance of the OTRA-based SGI demonstrated in Fig. 9.10 [8]. Solution 9.7 The input impedance of the SGI in Fig. 9.10 is obtained by using the following five equations: V in I in
ð9:18aÞ
V in V - Vo þ V in s3C þ in R R
ð9:18bÞ
V o = I P Rm - I N Rm
ð9:18cÞ
I P = V in s3C
ð9:18dÞ
Z in = I in =
Fig. 9.9 The symbol of the OTRA
VP
IP
VN
IN
P
OTRA
O
N
IO
R
Fig. 9.10 The OTRAbased SGI
R
Vin
R
Iin
N
OTRA P
3C
Zin
C
O
VO
9.3
OTRA
233
Fig. 9.11 The OTRAbased non-inverting firstorder VM APF
P
OTRA
O
N
R/ R/
C
Vin
R
V in Vo = IN 1 R R þ sC
Vout
ð9:18eÞ
From above equations, input impedance is computed as Z in =
R2 ðsCR þ sCR þ 1Þ V in = 2 2 3 m I in s 3C R þ s5CR2 þ 2R þ Rm
ð9:19Þ
Here, if Rm goes to infinity, the input impedance simplifies as Z in =
V in R2 sCRm = = sCR2 = sLeq I in Rm
ð9:20Þ
where Leq = CR2. Example 9.8 Find the transfer function (TF) of the OTRA-based non-inverting first-order voltage-mode (VM) all-pass filter (APF) in Fig. 9.11 [9]. Solution 9.8 The TF of the OTRA-based non-inverting first-order VM APF in Fig. 9.11 is calculated by using the following four equations: H ðsÞ = IN =
V out V in
V in V o þ R= R=
ð9:21aÞ ð9:21bÞ
I P = 0 ) V o = - I N Rm
ð9:21cÞ
V in - V out = ðV out - V o ÞsC R
ð9:21dÞ
From above equations, and assuming Rm goes to infinity, the TF is found and simplified as follows:
234
9
Fig. 9.12 Implementation of the OTRA by using two CFOAs
Y VP
VN
(1)
CFOA W
IP
Z
X
X
IN
(2)
VX
VY
H ðsÞ =
IO
CFOA W Y
Fig. 9.13 The symbol of the FTFN
Other Active Devices
IX IY
Z
Z
X
FTFN Y
R= þ Rm ð1 - sCRÞ V out = = V in R þ Rm ð1 þ sCRÞ R ð1 - sCRÞ 1 - sCR = m = Rm ð1 þ sCRÞ 1 þ sCR
W
IZ IW
VO
VZ VW
ð9:22Þ
Note The topology in Fig. 9.11 has a single passive resistive matching condition. Also, if R and C are interchanged in Fig. 9.11, an inverting first-order VM APF can be easily obtained. Example 9.9 Realize the OTRA with CFOAs. Solution 9.9 Realization of the OTRA by using two CFOAs is demonstrated in Fig. 9.12.
9.4
FTFN
The symbol of the FTFN is illustrated in Fig. 9.13, while the FTFN can be expressed with the matrix equation in (9.23).
9.4
FTFN
235 C
Fig. 9.14 The NFTFNbased inverting first-order VM APF circuit
Vin
Vout
Z
X
NFTFN W
Y
R
R
IY IX VX IW
=
0
0
0 0
VY
0
0
0 0
IZ
1 0
0 ∓1
0 0 0 0
VZ VW
ð9:23Þ
Here, - and + sign correspond to minus-type FTFN (NFTFN) and plus-type FTFN (PFTFN), respectively. Example 9.10 Find the TF of the NFTFN-based inverting first-order VM APF in Fig. 9.14 [10]. Solution 9.10 The TF of the NFTFN-based inverting first-order VM APF in Fig. 9.14 is computed by using the following two equations: H ðsÞ =
V out V in
ðV in - V out ÞsC =
V in V out þ R R
ð9:24aÞ ð9:24bÞ
From above equations, the following TF is found: H ðsÞ =
1 - sCR V out =1 þ sCR V in
ð9:25Þ
Example 9.11 Find the input admittance of the PFTFN-based SGI depicted in Fig. 9.15 [11]. Solution 9.11 The input admittance of the PFTFN-based SGI in Fig. 9.15 is found by using the following five equations:
236
9
Other Active Devices
R3
Fig. 9.15 The PFTFNbased SGI R4
Vin
W
I1
Iin
PFTFN Z
I1
R2
X
Y
Zin V2
V1
C
R1
Y in = I in = I 1 þ
I in V in
ð9:26aÞ
V in - V 1 V in - V 1 þ R4 R3
V in - V 1 V 1 = R4 R2
ð9:26bÞ ð9:26cÞ
V2 R1
ð9:26dÞ
V in - V 1 = ðV 1 - V 2 ÞsC R3
ð9:26eÞ
ðV 1 - V 2 ÞsC = I 1 þ
From above equations, the input admittance is evaluated as Y in =
I in 1 R R 1 1 1 = 1þ2 4 - 2 = þ ð9:27Þ þ V in sCR R 1 þ R2 R3 R1 R2 þ R4 sLeq Req 1 3 R4
where Leq and Req are, respectively, found by Leq = CR1 R3 1 þ Req =
R2 R4
ð9:28aÞ
1 1 R2 þR4
1 þ 2 RR43 -
R2 R1
ð9:28bÞ
If Req is taken as infinity, a positive lossless SGI is obtained, which is achieved with the following condition:
9.4
FTFN
237 R2
Fig. 9.16 The PFTFNbased parallel RL topology
Vin
I1
Iin
I1
W
X
PFTFN Z
Zin Vtest
Y
C
R1
1þ2
R4 R2 = R3 R1
ð9:29Þ
Example 9.12 Find the input admittance of the PFTFN-based parallel RL circuit in Fig. 9.16 [11]. Solution 9.12 The input admittance of the PFTFN-based parallel RL structure in Fig. 9.16 is found by using the following four equations: Y in =
I in V in
I in = I 1 þ
ð9:30aÞ
V in R2
- V test sC = I 1 þ
ð9:30bÞ V test R1
V in = - V test sC R2
ð9:30cÞ ð9:30dÞ
From above equations, the input admittance is calculated as follows: Y in =
I in 1 2 1 1 = þ = þ V in sCR1 R2 R2 sLeq Req
ð9:31Þ
Here, Leq = CR1R2 and Req = R2/2. Example 9.13 Find the input impedance of the PFTFN and INIC-based parallel SGI in Fig. 9.17 [12]. Solution 9.13 The input impedance of the PFTFN and INIC-based parallel SGI in Fig. 9.17 is found by using the following four equations:
238
9
INIC
1
Vin
R2
2
W
I1
Iin
Other Active Devices
X
PFTFN Z
I1
Y
Zin Vtest
C
R1
Fig. 9.17 The PFTFN and INIC-based positive lossless SGI
Z in =
V in I in
I in = I 1 -
ð9:32aÞ
V in R2
- V test sC = I 1 þ
V test R1
V in = - V test sC R2
ð9:32bÞ ð9:32cÞ ð9:32dÞ
From above equations, the input impedance is calculated by Z in =
V in = sCR1 R2 = sLeq I in
ð9:33Þ
Here, Leq = CR1R2. Example 9.14 Implement the NFTFN and PFTFN by using the CFOAs. Solution 9.14 Implementations of the NFTFN and PFTFN by using two CFOAs are, respectively, shown in Figs. 9.18 and 9.19 [13].
9.5
OTA
The symbol of the dual output OTA (DO-OTA) is given in Fig. 9.20. The DO-OTA can be expressed with the following matrix equation:
9.5
OTA
239
Fig. 9.18 NFTFN implementation based on two CFOAs
IX
VX
Y
IW (1) Z
X
(2)
CFOA W VY
IY
Y
Z
IW X
VX
IX
X
IZ
VZ
VW
(2)
CFOA W Z
Y
(1) Z
IZ
CFOA W VY
VW
CFOA W X
VZ
Y
IY
Fig. 9.19 PFTFN realization based on two CFOAs Fig. 9.20 The symbol of the DO-OTA
V1
V2
I1 I2 I Oþ IO -
=
+
I1
DO-OTA -
I2
0
0
0
0
V1
0 - gm
0 gm
0 0
0 0
V2 V Oþ
gm
- gm
0
0
VO -
O+ O-
IO+ IO-
VO+
VO-
ð9:34Þ
Example 9.15 Find the input impedance of the OTA-based positive lossless SGI in Fig. 9.21 [14]. Solution 9.15 The input impedance of the OTA-based positive lossless SGI in Fig. 9.21 is found by using the following five equations:
240
9
Vin
Iin
+
Other Active Devices
Vtest
(1)
OTA
O+
-
(2)
OTA
+
C
Zin
O+
Fig. 9.21 The OTA-based SGI topology Fig. 9.22 The symbol of the VDIBA
V1
V2
Z in =
I1 I2
+
W
VDIBA -
V in I in
Z
IW IZ
VW VZ
ð9:35aÞ
I O1þ = - V 1þ gm1
ð9:35bÞ
V in = V 1þ
ð9:35cÞ
I O1þ = - V test sC
ð9:35dÞ
I in = V 2 - gm2 = V test gm2
ð9:35eÞ
From above equations, the input impedance is computed as Z in =
V in sC = = sLeq I in gm1 gm2
ð9:36Þ
where Leq = C/(gm1gm2).
9.6
VDIBA
The symbol of the VDIBA is shown in Fig. 9.22. The VDIBA can be defined with the following matrix equation:
9.6
VDIBA
241
Fig. 9.23 The VDIBAbased first-order VM APF structure
+
W
Vo1
Z
Vo2
VDIBA Vin
-
C
0
I1 I2 IZ VW
=
0
0
0
- gm 0
gm 0
0
0
0
0
V2
0 0 -1 0
VZ IW
V1 ð9:37Þ
Example 9.16 Find the TFs of the VDIBA-based first-order VM APF in Fig. 9.23 [15]. This filter simultaneously provides both non-inverting and inverting responses. Solution 9.16 The TFs of the VDIBA-based first-order VM APF in Fig. 9.23 are evaluated by using the following four equations: H 1 ðsÞ =
V o1 V in
ð9:38aÞ
H 2 ðsÞ =
V o2 V in
ð9:38bÞ
V o1 = - V o2
ð9:38cÞ
I Z = ðV in - V o2 ÞsC = gm ðV in - V o1 Þ
ð9:38dÞ
From above equations, the following non-inverting and inverting first-order VM TFs are, respectively, obtained: H 1 ðsÞ =
1 - gsC g - sC V o1 m = m = V in gm þ sC 1 þ sC g
ð9:39aÞ
m
H 2 ðsÞ =
1 - sC g - sC V o2 gm =- m =gm þ sC V in 1 þ sC g m
ð9:39bÞ
242
9.7
9
Other Active Devices
VDBA
The symbol of the VDBA is demonstrated in Fig. 9.24. The VDBA can be expressed with the following matrix equation: IP
0
0
0
IN IZ
0 - gm
0 gm
0 0
VP VN
I ZC -
gm
- gm
0
VZ
VW
0
0
1
=
ð9:40Þ
Example 9.17 Find the input impedance of the VDBA-based positive lossless SGI in Fig. 9.25 [16]. Solution 9.17 The input impedance of the VDBA-based positive lossless SGI in Fig. 9.25 is calculated by using the following three equations:
Fig. 9.24 The symbol of the VDBA
VP
VN
P
IP IN
W
N
ZC-
VW
IW
VDBA Z
VZ
IZ
IZCVZC-
R
Fig. 9.25 The VDBAbased SGI circuit P
W
VDBA Vin
Iin
N
ZC-
Z
Vtest C
Zin
9.8
CDBA
243
V in I in
ð9:41aÞ
V in - V test R
ð9:41bÞ
Z in = I in =
I Z = V in gm = ðV in - V test ÞsC
ð9:41cÞ
From above equations, the input impedance is found below. Z in =
V in sCR = = sLeq I in gm
ð9:42Þ
Here, Leq = CR/gm.
9.8
CDBA
The symbol of the CDBA is depicted in Fig. 9.26. The CDBA can be defined with the following matrix equation: VP VN IZ VW
=
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
IP IN
-1 1
0
0
VZ
1
0
IW
0
0
ð9:43Þ
Example 9.18 Find the input impedance of the CDBA-based positive lossless SGI in Fig. 9.27 [17]. Solution 9.18 The input impedance of the CDBA-based positive lossless SGI in Fig. 9.27 is computed by using the following five equations: Z in =
V in I in
I in = I Z1 = I N1 =
Fig. 9.26 The symbol of the CDBA
VP
VN
IP IN
ð9:44aÞ V test R2
ð9:44bÞ
P
W
CDBA N
Z
IW IZ
VW VZ
244
9
Fig. 9.27 The CDBAbased SGI circuit
Vin
Other Active Devices
Z
Iin
(1)
W
Zin
P
CDBA N
R2
R1 P
(2)
W
CDBA
Vtest
Z
N
C
Fig. 9.28 Implementation of the CDBA by using two CFOAs
Y
VP VN
(1)
CFOA W
IP
X
Z
X
IN
CFOA W Y
I Z2 = - I P2 I P2 =
IZ (2) Z
V in R1
I Z2 = - V test sC
IW
VZ VW
ð9:44cÞ ð9:44dÞ ð9:44eÞ
From above equations, the input impedance is computed as Z in =
V in = sCR1 R2 = sLeq I in
ð9:45Þ
where Leq = CR1R2. Example 9.19 Realize the CDBA by using CFOAs. Solution 9.19 Realization of the CDBA by using two CFOAs is depicted in Fig. 9.28.
9.9
9.9
CA
245
CA
The symbol of the CA is given in Fig. 9.29. The CA can be defined with the following matrix equation: I in I outþ I out -
=
gm
0 0
V in
- gm gm
0 0 0 0
V outþ V out -
ð9:46Þ
Example 9.20 Find the input impedance of the CA-based positive lossless SGI in Fig. 9.30 [18]. Solution 9.20 The input impedance of the CA-based positive lossless SGI in Fig. 9.30 is calculated by using the following three equations: Z in =
V in I in
ð9:47aÞ
I in = V test gm2
ð9:47bÞ
gm1 V in = V test sC ) V test =
gm1 V in sC
ð9:47cÞ
From above equations, the input impedance is computed as
Fig. 9.29 The symbol of the CA
OUT+
Vin
Iin
IN
CA
Vout+
Iout+
OUT-
Vout-
Iout-
Fig. 9.30 The CA-based SGI topology (1) OUT+
Vin
Iin
IN
CA
Vtest
OUT+
C
Zin
OUT- (2)
CA OUT+
IN
246
9
Z in =
Other Active Devices
V in sC = = sLeq I in gm1 gm2
ð9:48Þ
where Leq = C/(gm1gm2).
9.10 CFTA The symbol of the CFTA is shown in Fig. 9.31. The CFTA can be defined with the following matrix equation: VF IZ I Xþ IX -
=
0 1
0 0
0 0
0 0
IF VZ
0
gm
0
0
V Xþ
0
- gm
0
0
VX -
ð9:49Þ
Example 9.21 Find the input impedance of the CFTA-based positive lossless SGI in Fig. 9.32 [19]. Solution 9.21 The input impedance of the CFTA-based positive lossless SGI in Fig. 9.32 is evaluated by using the following four equations:
Fig. 9.31 The symbol of the CFTA
VF VZ
Fig. 9.32 The CFTA-based SGI structure
F
IF
X+
X-
Z
IZ
Zin
Iin
Z
VX-
IX(1)
Vin
VX+
IX+
CFTA
X+
CFTA
X-
F
F
(2)
X+
Z
X-
CFTA
C
9.11
CDTA
247
Z in =
V in I in
ð9:50aÞ
I in = I F1 = - I X2þ = - gm2 V Z2
ð9:50bÞ
I F2 = I Z2 = - I X1 - = gm1 V in
ð9:50cÞ
V Z2 = -
I Z2 sC
ð9:50dÞ
From above equations, the input impedance is found as follows: Z in =
V in sC = = sLeq I in gm1 gm2
ð9:51Þ
where Leq = C/(gm1gm2).
9.11 CDTA The symbol of the CDTA is given in Fig. 9.33. The CDTA can be expressed with the following matrix equation: VP
0
0
0
0
0
IP
VN IZ
0 -1
0 1
0 0
0 0
0 0
IN VZ
0 0
0 0
- gm gm
0 0
0 0
V Xþ VX -
I Xþ IX -
=
ð9:52Þ
Example 9.22 Find the input impedance of the CDTA-based SGI in Fig. 9.34 [20]. Solution 9.22 The input impedance of the CDTA-based positive lossless SGI in Fig. 9.34 is found by using the following eight equations:
Fig. 9.33 The symbol of the CDTA
VP VN
IP IN
P
X+
CDTA N
X-
Z
IZ
VZ
IX+ IX-
VX+
VX-
248
9
N
(1)
P
X+
CDTA P
Vin
Z
(2)
X+
Z
X-
Other Active Devices
CDTA X-
N
C
Iin
Zin Fig. 9.34 The CDTA-based SGI circuit
Z in =
V in I in
ð9:53aÞ
I in = I N1 - I P1
ð9:53bÞ
I N1 = gm2 V Z2
ð9:53cÞ
I P1 = - gm2 V Z2
ð9:53dÞ
I Z2 = - sCV Z2
ð9:53eÞ
I Z2 = I N2 - I P2
ð9:53f Þ
I N2 = - gm1 V in
ð9:53gÞ
I P2 = gm1 V in
ð9:53gÞ
From above equations, the input impedance is found below. Z in =
V in sC = = sLeq I in 4gm1 gm2
ð9:54Þ
Here, Leq = C/(4gm1gm2).
9.12
DVCCTA
The symbol of the dual output DVCCTA (DO-DVCCTA) is demonstrated in Fig. 9.35. The DO-DVCCTA can be defined with the following matrix equation:
9.12
DVCCTA
249
Fig. 9.35 The symbol of the DO-DVCCTA
IY1
VY1
Y1
O+
DO-DVCCTA VY2
Y2
IY2
X
VZ
VX
V1
VO-
IO-
IZ
IX
Fig. 9.36 The DODVCCTA-based SFI circuit
O-
Z
VO+
IO+
I1
Y1
O-
DO-DVCCTA V2
Y2
I2
X
R
I Y1 I Y2 VX IZ I Oþ IO -
=
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
V Y1 V Y2
1
-1
0
0
0
0
IX
0 0
0 0
1 0
0 - gm
0 0
0 0
VZ V Oþ
0
0
0
gm
0
0
VO -
Z
O+
C
ð9:55Þ
Example 9.23 Find the admittance matrix equation of the DO-DVCCTA-based positive lossless SFI in Fig. 9.36 [21]. Solution 9.23 The admittance matrix equation of the DO-DVCCTA-based positive lossless SFI in Fig. 9.36 is calculated by using the following five equations: I2 = - I1
ð9:56aÞ
VX = V1 - V2
ð9:56bÞ
VX = V Z sC R
ð9:56cÞ
250
9
Other Active Devices
I 1 = gm V Z
ð9:56dÞ
I 2 = - gm V Z
ð9:56eÞ
From above equations, the admittance matrix equation is computed by I1 g = m sCR I2
1 -1
-1 1
V1 1 = sLeq V2
1 -1
-1 1
V1 V2
ð9:57Þ
where Leq = CR/gm.
9.13
COA
The symbol of the COA is given in Fig. 9.37. The COA can be expressed by the following four equations: VP = 0
ð9:58aÞ
VN = 0
ð9:58bÞ
I Z = B ðI N - I P Þ
ð9:58cÞ
IW = - IZ
ð9:58dÞ
Here, B is ideally infinity. Example 9.24 Find the TF of the COA-based non-inverting first-order currentmode APF in Fig. 9.38 [22]. Solution 9.24 The TF of the COA-based non-inverting first-order current-mode APF in Fig. 9.38 is computed by using the following six equations:
Fig. 9.37 The symbol of the COA
VP
IP
P
COA VN
N
IN
IZ
Z W
P
Iin
COA
Vtest R
N
VW
IW
C
Fig. 9.38 The COA-based first-order APF circuit
VZ
Z W
Iout
References
251
I in = V test sC þ
1 R
ð9:59aÞ
I out = - I Z
ð9:59bÞ
IW = - IZ
ð9:59cÞ
I Z = B ðI N - I P Þ
ð9:59dÞ
V test - IW R
ð9:59eÞ
IN =
I P = V test sC
ð9:59f Þ
From above equations, the TF is computed as follows: ð1 - sCRÞ I out = I in 1 - B1 ð1 þ sCRÞ
ð9:60Þ
If B is infinity, equation given in (9.60) simplifies as 1 - sCR I out = I in 1 þ sCR
ð9:61Þ
It is observed from equation in (9.61) that a non-inverting first-order APF TF is obtained. If R and C are interchanged, an inverting first-order APF TF is obtained. Note One observes throughout of this chapter that other active devices can be easily obtained from combination of the OTA(s) and CC(s).
References 1. Analog Devices, AD844 SPICE Macro Model Rev. A, 7/91. https://www.analog.com/en/ license/spice-models?mediaPath=media/en/simulation-models/spice-models/ad844.cir& modelType=spice-models. Accessed 20 Dec 2022 2. E. Yuce, Novel lossless and lossy grounded inductor simulators consisting of a canonical number of components. Analog Integr. Circ. Sig. Process 59, 77–82 (2009) 3. A. Fabre, Gyrator implementation from commercially available transimpedance operational amplifiers. Electron. Lett. 28, 263–264 (1992) 4. E. Yuce, S. Minaei, Commercially available active device based grounded inductor simulator and universal filter with improved low frequency performances. J. Circuit. Syst. Comput. 26(4), 1750052 (2017) 5. A. Toker, O. Cicekoglu, H. Kuntman, New active gyrator circuit suitable for frequencydependent negative resistor implementation. Microelectron. J. 30(1), 59–62 (1999) 6. R. Senani, Realization of a class of analog signal processing/signal generation circuits: Novel configurations using current feedback op-amps. Frequenz 52(9–10), 196–206 (1998) 7. P.A. Martinez, J. Sabadell, C. Aldea, Grounded resistor controlled sinusoidal oscillator using CFOAs. Electron. Lett. 33(5), 346–348 (1997)
252
9
Other Active Devices
8. R. Pandey, N. Pandey, S.K. Paul, A. Singh, B. Sriram, K. Trivedi, Novel grounded inductance simulator using single OTRA. Int. J. Circuit Theory Appl. 42(10), 1069–1079 (2014) 9. C. Cakir, U. Cam, O. Cicekoglu, Novel allpass filter configuration employing single OTRA. IEEE Trans. Circuit. Syst. II Express Briefs 52(3), 122–125 (2005) 10. U. Cam, O. Cicekoglu, M. Gulsoy, H. Kuntman, New voltage and current mode first-order all-pass filters using single FTFN. Frequenz 54(7–8), 177–179 (2000) 11. P. Kumar, R. Senani, New grounded simulated inductance circuit using a single PFTFN. Analog Integr. Circ. Sig. Process 62, 105–112 (2010) 12. S. Tez, O.M. Tez, E. Yuce, Derivation of Lossless Grounded Inductor Simulators Based on Active Circuit Elements (ICAT, Antalya, 2018) 13. U. Cam, O. Cicekoglu, H. Kuntman, Universal series and parallel immittance simulators using four terminal floating nullors. Analog Integr. Circ. Sig. Process 25, 59–66 (2000) 14. R.L. Geiger, E. Sanchez-Sinencio, Active filter design using operational transconductance amplifiers: A tutorial. IEEE Circuit. Devices Magaz. 1(2), 20–32 (1985) 15. N. Herencsar, S. Minaei, J. Koton, E. Yuce, K. Vrba, New resistorless and electronically tunable realization of dual-output VM all-pass filter using VDIBA. Analog Integr. Circ. Sig. Process 74(1), 141–154 (2013) 16. A. Yesil, F. Kacar, K. Gurkan, Lossless grounded inductance simulator employing single VDBA and its experimental band-pass filter application. AEU Int. J. Electron. Commun. 68(2), 143–150 (2014) 17. A. Toker, S. Ozoguz, C. Acar, CDBA-based fully-integrated gyrator circuit suitable for electronically tunable inductance simulation. AEU Int. J. Electron. Commun. 54(5), 293–296 (2000) 18. C. Psychalinos, A. Spanidou, Current amplifier based grounded and floating inductance simulators. AEU Int. J. Electron. Commun. 60(2), 168–171 (2006) 19. N. Herencsar, J. Koton, K. Vrbra, CFTA-based active-C grounded positive inductance simulator and its application. Elektrorevue 1(1), 24–27 (2010) 20. D. Prasad, D.R. Bhaskar, A.K. Singh, New grounded and floating simulated inductance circuits using current differencing transconductance amplifiers. Radioengineering 19(1), 194–198 (2010) 21. W. Tangsrirat, Floating simulator with a single DVCCTA. Indian J. Eng. Mater. Sci. 20(2), 79–86 (2013) 22. S. Kilinc, U. Cam, Current-mode first-order allpass filter employing single current operational amplifier. Analog Integr. Circ. Sig. Process 41, 47–53 (2004)
Correction to: Unity Gain Cells
Correction to: Chapter 6 in: E. Yuce, S. Minaei, Passive and Active Circuits by Example, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6_6 The value of equation under Solution 6.7 has been corrected retrospectively to prevent any consequential errors.
The updated version of this chapter can be found at https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6_6 © The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2024 E. Yuce, S. Minaei, Passive and Active Circuits by Example, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6_10
C1
Index
A Admittance, 35, 36, 42–44, 169, 170, 185, 186, 196, 197, 202, 203, 208, 211, 212, 219–221, 230, 235–237, 249, 250 All-pass filter (APF), 17–19, 21, 23, 26, 27, 29, 31, 75, 78–79, 82, 85, 138, 158–162, 164, 176–178, 205, 212, 214–216, 233–235, 241, 250 Amplifiers, 13, 92–96, 98, 99, 108–120, 144, 149, 154, 191 Angular pole frequency, 31, 76, 80, 81, 110, 111, 116, 205 Angular resonance frequency, 8, 18, 22, 139 Attenuator, 154
B Band-pass filter (BPF), 17–20, 22–24, 26, 29, 82, 83, 85, 86, 141–143 Bandwidth (BW), 17, 18, 22, 65, 91, 118–120, 189 Bipolar junction transistor (BJT), 9, 98, 99
C C, 73, 75, 77, 79, 234, 251 Capacitors, 35–43, 46–49, 51–53, 59–61, 64, 91 Causality, 12, 15 Complex frequency domain, 35 Constant function, 1, 3 Current amplifier, 225 Current controlled CCII (CCCII), 189, 203–204 Current conveyors (CCs), 189–222, 251
Current differencing buffered amplifier (CDBA), 225, 243–244 Current differencing transconductance amplifier (CDTA), 225, 247–248 Current feedback operational amplifier (CFOA), 225–231 Current follower (CF), 151–153, 157–163, 165, 194 Current follower transconductance amplifier (CFTA), 225, 246–247 Current-mode (CM), 73, 74, 79–81, 84–86, 151, 158, 159, 164, 165, 167, 175, 176, 178, 179, 204, 205, 250 Current operational amplifier (COA), 225, 250–251
D DCCII, 206–207 Delta function, 2 Differential difference CC (DDCC), 189, 213–216 Differential voltage CC (DVCC), 189, 209–213 Differential voltage current conveyor transconductance amplifier (DVCCTA), 225, 248–250 Dual output DCCII (DO-DCCII), 206 Dual output ICCII (DO-ICCII), 204 Dual X CCII (DX-CCII), 189
E EX-CCCII, 189, 221, 222 Exponential function, 2, 7, 63
© The Editor(s) (if applicable) and The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2024 E. Yuce, S. Minaei, Passive and Active Circuits by Example, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-44966-6
253
254 F First-generation CC (CCI), 189–193 First-order, 29–33, 46, 56, 75–81, 101–103, 138, 156–162, 164, 167, 176–180, 204, 205, 212, 214, 215, 233–235, 241, 250, 251 First-order analog filters, 138 First-order transfer function, 75–78, 160–162, 176–178, 180, 204, 212, 233, 235, 241, 250 Floating, 35, 40–42, 78, 123, 164, 185, 186 Fourier transforms, 15–16 Four-terminal floating nullor (FTFN), 225, 234, 235 Frequency dependent negative resistor (FDNR), 229 Frequency domain, 16, 22, 23, 26, 27, 31, 35, 37, 38, 43, 44, 56, 58–60, 66, 68, 69, 71, 76–78, 110, 116–118, 169, 170 Full-power bandwidth, 149–150 Full-wave rectified function, 1 Full-wave rectifier (FWR), 2, 4, 11, 132–135, 212, 213 Fully differential CCII (FDCCII), 189, 216–218
G Grounded, 35–39, 123, 181, 229
H Half-wave rectifiers (HWRs), 132 High-order transfer function, vi, 86 High-pass filter (HPF), 17–19, 21, 23, 25–27, 29, 30, 32, 75, 77–78, 80–83, 85, 101, 102, 157, 168, 205
I ICCII, 189, 204–206 Ideal filters, 17–19 Ideal first-order filter, 29–34 Ideal OAs, 90–92 Ideal second-order filters, 19–29 Impedance, 2, 73, 123, 151, 181, 190, 226 Inductor, 35, 36, 38–42, 46, 54–58, 61, 64, 123, 169, 171, 190, 195–198, 201–203 Instrumentation amplifier (IA), 163, 195, 209, 210
L L, 73, 75, 77, 79 Laplace transform, 15, 73
Index Linear time-invariant (LTI), 11, 12, 16, 73 Linearity, 11, 189 Lossless, 57–61, 123, 128–132, 165, 169, 171–173, 184, 185, 190, 207, 209, 221, 222, 229, 230, 236, 238, 239, 242, 243, 245–247, 249 Lossy, 123–128, 168–171, 182, 183, 190, 201–203 Low-pass filter (LPF), 17, 19, 22–24, 26–30, 32–34, 75–76, 80, 82, 84–86, 101, 102, 139–141, 156, 168, 205
M Magnitude, 8, 16, 27, 36–40, 43, 44, 57–59, 61, 66–72, 89, 110, 116, 132, 168, 169, 171
N Negative impedance converter (NIC), 175, 179–188, 194 Non-linearity, v Notch filter (NF), 17–20, 22, 23, 25–27, 82, 83, 85
O Operating frequency range, 57–60, 168, 169, 171 Operational amplifier (OA), 89–150, 189 Operational transconductance amplifier (OTA), 225, 238–241, 251 Operational transresistance amplifier (OTRA), 225, 232–234
P Parallel, 8, 42, 43, 53, 57–61, 63, 65–68, 70, 71, 123, 124, 168–171, 182, 202, 203, 220, 237 Passive elements, 8, 35, 36, 86 Phase, 1, 16, 19–27, 29–34, 36–40, 43, 44, 56–59, 61, 65–72, 76, 77, 79, 86, 92, 116, 168, 169, 171, 205 Positive half-wave rectified function, 1 Practical OA, 90 Prefixes, 1, 3
Q Quadrature oscillator (QA), 192, 231 Quality factor, 18–22, 24–26, 56, 139
Index R R, 73, 75, 79, 155, 156, 178, 182–184, 188, 234, 251 RC circuit, 46, 56, 59, 60, 79 Resistor, 9, 11, 35–41, 43, 46–49, 51, 53, 54, 56, 61, 64, 91, 96, 99, 107, 120, 164, 203, 229 RL topology, 56, 57, 237 RLC structure, 64, 71
S Sawtooth wave function, 2, 6 s domain, 35, 40, 44, 45, 56, 57, 59, 60, 97, 110, 145, 146, 169, 170 Second-generation CC (CCII), 189, 193–201, 225, 226 Second-order analog filters, 138 Second-order filters, 138 Second-order transfer function, 139–143 Second-order universal filter, 19, 27 Sensitivity, 6–10 Series, 8, 42, 43, 56, 57, 59, 64–66, 69, 125–127, 183, 201, 202, 226 Signal, 2, 11–15, 39, 92, 144–146 Simulated floating inductor (SFI), 190, 196–198, 211, 212, 230, 249 Simulated grounded inductor (SGI), 123–132, 165, 168–173, 182–185, 190–192, 195, 196, 203, 204, 206–210, 217, 220, 222, 227–229, 232, 235–240, 242–248 Sine wave function, 1, 4 Slew rate (SR), 91, 145–149 Some basic circuits, 92–108 Square wave function, 2, 5 Stability, 15, 44, 92 Subtractor connected CCI (S-CCI), 189 Symbols, 1–3, 35, 89, 151, 152, 163, 164, 166, 175, 176, 179, 180, 189, 190, 193, 194, 201, 203, 204, 206–209, 213, 214, 216,
255 218, 219, 221, 225, 226, 232, 234, 238–240, 242, 243, 245–250 Systems, 1, 2, 11–15, 73
T Third-generation CC (CCIII), 189, 201–203 Time domain, 16, 35, 39, 47–56, 97 Time-invariant, 12 Time-variant, v Total harmonic distortion (THD), 13, 14, 91 Transadmittance-mode (TAM), 73–75 Triangular wave function, 2, 6
U Unit ramp functions, 1, 3 Unit step function, 2 Units, 1–3, 145 Unity gain cells (UGCs), 151–173 Unity gain inverting amplifier (UGIA), 82, 175–179, 191
V Voltage differencing buffer amplifier, 225 Voltage differencing inverting buffered amplifier, 225 Voltage follower (VF), 105, 108, 110, 112, 145–149, 151, 166, 167, 176, 177, 187, 191, 194, 225, 226 Voltage-mode (VM), 73–79, 81–84, 86, 153–162, 167, 176–178, 180, 187, 188, 212–215, 233–235, 241
W Wien oscillators, 135–138, 186, 187